blob: 7c6684b94208c140a8493a81c33830215958e912 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaub3066502017-11-26 19:50:17 +01005 version 1.9
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau27010f02018-09-29 20:17:33 +02007 2018/09/29
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011110. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011210.1. Limitation
11310.2. Setup
11410.2.1. Cache section
11510.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116
1171. Quick reminder about HTTP
118----------------------------
119
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
122on almost anything found in the contents.
123
124However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
125formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
126correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
127
128
1291.1. The HTTP transaction model
130-------------------------------
131
132The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100133to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
135connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136will involve a new connection :
137
138 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
139
140In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
141establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
142by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
143length.
144
145Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
146to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
147however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
148response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
149header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
154power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
155but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200156a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100158Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
160second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
161page :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
166latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
167correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
168the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100169server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
172time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
173are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
174parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
175carry the stream identifier.
176
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100177By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
178connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
179leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100180start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
181processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
182waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200183
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100184HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
185 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
186 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
187 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
188 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
190 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100599 - wurfl-data-file
600 - wurfl-information-list
601 - wurfl-information-list-separator
602 - wurfl-engine-mode
603 - wurfl-cache-size
604 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200623 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200624 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200625 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000626 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000627 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200628 - tune.buffers.limit
629 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200630 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200631 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100632 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200633 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200634 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200635 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100636 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200637 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200638 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100639 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100640 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100641 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100642 - tune.lua.session-timeout
643 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200644 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100645 - tune.maxaccept
646 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200647 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200648 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200649 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100650 - tune.rcvbuf.client
651 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100652 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200653 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100654 - tune.sndbuf.client
655 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100656 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100657 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200658 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100659 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200660 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200661 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100662 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200663 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100664 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200665 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
666 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
667 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100668 - tune.zlib.memlevel
669 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671 * Debugging
672 - debug
673 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674
675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006763.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200677------------------------------------
678
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200679ca-base <dir>
680 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200681 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
682 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200683
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200684chroot <jail dir>
685 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
686 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
687 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
688 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
689 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100690 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100692cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
693 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
694 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
695 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
696 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
697 set. These sets have the format
698
699 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
700
701 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100702 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100703 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
704 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100705 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
706 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100707 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100708 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100709 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
712 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
713 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
714 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100715
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100716 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
717 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
718 on the machine's word size.
719
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100720 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100721 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
722 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
723 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
724 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
725 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
726 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100727
728 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
730
731 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
732 # first 4 CPUs
733
734 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
735 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
736 # word size.
737
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100738 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
743
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100744 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
745 # and so on.
746 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
749
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100750 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100751 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
752 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
753 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
754
755 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
756 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
757 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
758
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
760 # and a thread range.
761 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
762 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
764
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200765crt-base <dir>
766 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
767 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
768 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770daemon
771 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
772 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100773 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
774 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200775
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200776deviceatlas-json-file <path>
777 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100778 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200779
780deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100781 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200782 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
783
784deviceatlas-separator <char>
785 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
786 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
787
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100788deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200789 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
790 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
791 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100792
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900793external-check
794 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
795 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
796 See "option external-check".
797
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200798gid <number>
799 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
800 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
801 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100802 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
803 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100805
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100806hard-stop-after <time>
807 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
808
809 Arguments :
810 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
811 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
812 SIGUSR1 signal.
813
814 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
815 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
816 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
817
818 Example:
819 global
820 hard-stop-after 30s
821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822group <group name>
823 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
824 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100825
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200826log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100827 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100829 configured with "log global".
830
831 <address> can be one of:
832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100833 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100834 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
835 port).
836
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100837 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
838 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
839 port).
840
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100841 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
842 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
843 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100844 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100845
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200846 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
847 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100848
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200849 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
850 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
851 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
852 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
853 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
854 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
855 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
856 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
857 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
858 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100859 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
860 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200861
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200862 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
863 one of the following :
864
865 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
866 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
867
868 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
869 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
870
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100871 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200872
873 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
874 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
875 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
876
877 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200878 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
879 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
880 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
881 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
882 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
883 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200884
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200885 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200886
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100887log-send-hostname [<string>]
888 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
889 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
890 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
891 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
892 the logs.
893
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000894log-tag <string>
895 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
896 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
897 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100898 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000899
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100900lua-load <file>
901 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
902 used multiple times.
903
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100904master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200905 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
906 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
907 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100908 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200909 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
910 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100911 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
912 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
913 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
914 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
915 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200916
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100917 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919nbproc <number>
920 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
921 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
922 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
923 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
924 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
925
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200926nbthread <number>
927 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
928 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
929 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
930 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
931 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
932
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200933pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100934 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200935 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
936 starting the process. See also "daemon".
937
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100938presetenv <name> <value>
939 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
940 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
941 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
942 and "unsetenv".
943
944resetenv [<name> ...]
945 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
946 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
947 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
948 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
949 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
950 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
951 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
952 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
953
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100954stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200955 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
956 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
957 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
958 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
959 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
960 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100961 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100962 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
963 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
964 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
965 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200966
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200967server-state-base <directory>
968 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200969 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
970 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200971
972server-state-file <file>
973 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
974 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
975 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
976 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
977 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
978 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
979 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
980 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200981 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
982 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200983
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100984setenv <name> <value>
985 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
986 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
987 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
988 and "unsetenv".
989
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100990ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
991 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
992 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200993 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 for all
994 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
995 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance
996 a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). For
997 TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites"
998 keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
999
1000ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1001 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1002 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1003 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1004 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1005 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1006 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites", and can
1007 be for instance a string such as
1008 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
1009 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
1010 the "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
1011 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001012
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001013ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1014 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1015 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1016 keyword to see available options.
1017
1018 Example:
1019 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001020 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001021
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001022ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1023 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1024 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001025 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 with the server,
1026 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
1027 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration,
1028 please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the
1029 "server" keyword for more information.
1030
1031ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1033 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1034 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1035 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1036 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1037 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration for
1038 TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword.
1039 Please check the "server" keyword for more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001040
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001041ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1042 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1043 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1044 keyword to see available options.
1045
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001046ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1047 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1048 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1049 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001050 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001051 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001052 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1053 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1054 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1055 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001056 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1057 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1058 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1059
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001060ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1061 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1062 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1063 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1064
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001065stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1066 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1067 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1068 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001069 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001070 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001071
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001072 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1073 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1074 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001075
1076stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1077 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1078 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001079 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001080
1081stats maxconn <connections>
1082 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1083 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1084
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085uid <number>
1086 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1087 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1088 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1089 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1090
1091ulimit-n <number>
1092 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1093 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1094 option.
1095
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001096unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1097 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1098
1099 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1100 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1101 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1102 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1103 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1104 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1105 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1106 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1107 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1108 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1109
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001110unsetenv [<name> ...]
1111 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1112 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1113 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1114 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1115 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1116 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1117 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1118
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001119user <user name>
1120 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1121 See also "uid" and "group".
1122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001123node <name>
1124 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1125
1126 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1127 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1128 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1129 traffic.
1130
1131description <text>
1132 Add a text that describes the instance.
1133
1134 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1135 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1136 "<" and ">" characters.
1137
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100113851degrees-data-file <file path>
1139 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001140 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001141
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001142 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001143 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1144
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000114551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001146 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1147 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1148 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1149
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001150 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001151 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1152
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200115351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001154 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1155 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1156
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001157 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1158 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1159
116051degrees-cache-size <number>
1161 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1162 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1163 By default, this cache is disabled.
1164
1165 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001166 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1167
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001168wurfl-data-file <file path>
1169 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1170 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1171
1172 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1173 with USE_WURFL=1.
1174
1175wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1176 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1177 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1178 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1179
1180 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1181
1182 Valid WURFL properties are:
1183 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1184
1185 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1186 device.
1187
1188 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1189 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1190
1191 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1192 particular web request.
1193
1194 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1195 used Libwurfl API version.
1196
1197 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1198 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1199 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1200
1201 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1202 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1203
1204 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1205 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1206
1207 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1208
1209 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1210
1211 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1212 with USE_WURFL=1.
1213
1214wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1215 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1216 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1217
1218 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1219 with USE_WURFL=1.
1220
1221wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1222 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1223 thus before the chroot.
1224
1225 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1226 with USE_WURFL=1.
1227
1228wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1229 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1230 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001231 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001232 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001233 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001234 mode is enabled by default.
1235
1236 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1237 with USE_WURFL=1.
1238
1239wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1240 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1241 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1242 - "0" : no cache is used.
1243 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1244 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1245 the highest performing option.
1246
1247 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1248 with USE_WURFL=1.
1249
1250wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1251 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1252 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1253
1254 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1255 with USE_WURFL=1.
1256
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012583.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001259-----------------------
1260
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001261max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1262 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1263 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1264 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1265 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1266 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1267 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1268 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1269 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1270
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001271maxconn <number>
1272 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1273 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1274 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001275 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1276 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1277 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1278 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001279 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1280 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1281 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1282 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1283 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001284
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001285maxconnrate <number>
1286 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1287 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1288 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1289 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1290 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1291 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1292 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1293 fairness.
1294
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001295maxcomprate <number>
1296 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001297 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001298 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1299 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1300 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001301 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001302 default value.
1303
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001304maxcompcpuusage <number>
1305 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1306 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1307 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1308 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1309 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1310 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1311 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1312 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1313
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001314maxpipes <number>
1315 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1316 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1317 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1318 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1319 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1320 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1321
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001322maxsessrate <number>
1323 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1324 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1325 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1326 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1327 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1328 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1329 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1330 fairness.
1331
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001332maxsslconn <number>
1333 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1334 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1335 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1336 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1337 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1338 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1339 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001340 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1341 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1342 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1343 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1344 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1345 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1346 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001347
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001348maxsslrate <number>
1349 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1350 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1351 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1352 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1353 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1354 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1355 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1356 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1357 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1358 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1359
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001360maxzlibmem <number>
1361 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1362 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1363 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001364 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1365 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1366 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1367
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001368noepoll
1369 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1370 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001371 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001372
1373nokqueue
1374 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1375 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1376 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1377
1378nopoll
1379 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1380 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001381 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001382 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001383
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001384nosplice
1385 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001386 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001387 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001388 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001389 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1390 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1391 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1392 "option splice-response".
1393
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001394nogetaddrinfo
1395 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1396 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1397
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001398noreuseport
1399 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1400 command line argument "-dR".
1401
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001402spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001403 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1404 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1405 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1406 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1407 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1408 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001409
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001410ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001411 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001412 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001413 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1414 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1415 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1416 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1417 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001418 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1419 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001420 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1421 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1422 openssl configuration file uses:
1423 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1424
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001425ssl-mode-async
1426 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001427 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001428 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1429 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1430 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1431 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1432 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001433
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001434tune.buffers.limit <number>
1435 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1436 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1437 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1438 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1439 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001440 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001441 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1442 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1443 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1444 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1445 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1446 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1447 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1448 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1449 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1450
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001451tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1452 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1453 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1454 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1455 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1456
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001457tune.bufsize <number>
1458 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1459 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1460 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1461 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1462 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1463 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1464 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001465 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1466 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1467 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001468 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1469 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001470
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001471tune.chksize <number>
1472 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1473 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1474 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1475 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1476 checks whenever possible.
1477
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001478tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1479 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1480 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1481 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1482 this value. The default value is 1.
1483
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001484tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1485 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1486 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1487 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1488 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1489 change it.
1490
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001491tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1492 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001493 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1494 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001495 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1496 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1497 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1498 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1499 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1500
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001501tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1502 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1503 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1504 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1505 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1506 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1507 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1508 recommended not to change this value.
1509
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001510tune.http.cookielen <number>
1511 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1512 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1513 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1514 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1515 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1516 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1517 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1518 to change this value.
1519
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001520tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001521 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1522 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001523 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001524 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001525 configuration directives too.
1526 The default value is 1024.
1527
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001528tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1529 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1530 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1531 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1532 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1533 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1534 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001535 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1536 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1537 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001538
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001539tune.idletimer <timeout>
1540 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1541 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1542 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1543 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1544 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1545 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001546 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001547 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1548 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1549
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001550tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1551 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001552 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001553 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1554 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001555 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001556 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1557 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1558
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001559tune.lua.maxmem
1560 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1561 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1562 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1563 memory.
1564
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001565tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1566 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001567 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1568 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001569 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001570
1571tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1572 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1573 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1574 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1575 check servers.
1576
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001577tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1578 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1579 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1580 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001581 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001582
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001583tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001584 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1585 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1586 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1587 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1588 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1589 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1590 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1591 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1592 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1593 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001594
1595tune.maxpollevents <number>
1596 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1597 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1598 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1599 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1600 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1601
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001602tune.maxrewrite <number>
1603 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1604 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1605 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1606 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1607 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1608 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1609 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1610 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1611 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1612 bufsize.
1613
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001614tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1615 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1616 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1617 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1618 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1619 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1620 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1621 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1622 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1623 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1624 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1625 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1626 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1627 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1628 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1629 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1630 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1631 setting this parameter to 0.
1632
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001633tune.pipesize <number>
1634 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1635 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1636 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1637 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1638 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1639 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1640
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001641tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1642tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1643 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1644 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1645 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1646 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001647 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001648 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1649 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1650
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001651tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001652 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001653 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1654 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1655 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1656 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1657
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001658tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1659 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1660 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1661 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1662
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001663tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1664tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1665 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1666 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1667 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1668 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001669 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001670 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1671 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1672 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1673 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1674 notifying haproxy again.
1675
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001676tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001677 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1678 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1679 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001680 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001681 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001682 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001683 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1684 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1685 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001686 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1687 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001688
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001689tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001690 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001691 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1692 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1693 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1694 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1695 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1696
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001697tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1698 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001699 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001700 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1701 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1702 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1703 being used for too long.
1704
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001705tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1706 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1707 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1708 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1709 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1710 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1711 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1712 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1713 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1714 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1715 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001716 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001717 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001718
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001719tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1720 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1721 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1722 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1723 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1724 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1725 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1726 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001727 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1728 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001729
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001730tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1731 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1732 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1733 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1734 1000 entries.
1735
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001736tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1737 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1738 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1739 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1740
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001741tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001742tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001743tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1744tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1745tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001746 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1747 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1748 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1749 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1750 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1751 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1752 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1753 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001754
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001755 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1756 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1757 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1758 all available space is consumed.
1759 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1760 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1761 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001762
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001763tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1764 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001765 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001766 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001767 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001768 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1769
1770tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1771 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1772 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001773 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1774 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017763.3. Debugging
1777--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001778
1779debug
1780 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1781 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1782 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1783 system startup.
1784
1785quiet
1786 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1787 line argument "-q".
1788
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017903.4. Userlists
1791--------------
1792It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1793http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1794it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1795
1796userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001797 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001798 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1799
1800group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001801 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001802 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1803 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1804
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001805user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1806 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001807 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1808 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001809 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1810 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1811 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1812 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001813
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001814 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1815 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1816 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1817 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1818 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1819 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1820 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1821 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1822 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001823
1824 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001825 userlist L1
1826 group G1 users tiger,scott
1827 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001828
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001829 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1830 user scott insecure-password elgato
1831 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001832
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001833 userlist L2
1834 group G1
1835 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001836
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001837 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1838 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1839 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001840
1841 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001842
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001843
18443.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001845----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001846It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1847several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1848instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1849values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1850automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1851In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1852using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1853tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1854reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1855Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1856that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1857each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001858
1859peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001860 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001861 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1862
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001863disabled
1864 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1865 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1866 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1867
1868enable
1869 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1870
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001871peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1872 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1873 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1874 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1875 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1876 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1877 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1878
1879 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1880 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1881
1882 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1883 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1884 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1885 across all peers.
1886
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001887 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1888 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001889
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001890 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001891 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001892 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1893 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1894 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001895
1896 backend mybackend
1897 mode tcp
1898 balance roundrobin
1899 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1900 stick on src
1901
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001902 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1903 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001904
1905
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090019063.6. Mailers
1907------------
1908It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1909If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1910in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1911
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001912mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001913 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1914 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1915
1916mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1917 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1918
1919 Example:
1920 mailers mymailers
1921 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1922 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1923
1924 backend mybackend
1925 mode tcp
1926 balance roundrobin
1927
1928 email-alert mailers mymailers
1929 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1930 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1931
1932 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1933 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1934
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001935timeout mail <time>
1936 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1937 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1938 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1939 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1940
1941 Example:
1942 mailers mymailers
1943 timeout mail 20s
1944 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019464. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001947----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001948
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001949Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001950 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001951 - frontend <name>
1952 - backend <name>
1953 - listen <name>
1954
1955A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1956its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1957section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001958section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001959
1960A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1961connections.
1962
1963A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1964to forward incoming connections.
1965
1966A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1967parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1968
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1970'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1971case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1972
1973Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1974logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1975proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1976However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1977name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1978
1979Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1980and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001981bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001982protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1983modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1984arbitrary criteria.
1985
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001986In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1987a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1988the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1989
1990 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1991 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1992 between responses and new requests.
1993
1994 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1995 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1996 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1997 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1998
1999 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
2000 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
2001 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
2002
2003 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2004 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2005 client-facing connection remains open.
2006
2007 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
2008 after the end of the response.
2009
2010The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2011frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2012following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
2013weakest option and force close is the strongest.
2014
2015 Backend mode
2016
2017 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
2018 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
2019 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
2020 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
2021 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
2022 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
2023 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
2024 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
2025 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
2026 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
2027 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
2028
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020314.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2032--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002034The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2035limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2036they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2037limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002038marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002039option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002040and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2041with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2042specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002044
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002045 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2046------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2047acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002048appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002049backlog X X X -
2050balance X - X X
2051bind - X X -
2052bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002053block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002054capture cookie - X X -
2055capture request header - X X -
2056capture response header - X X -
2057clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002058compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002059contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2060cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002061declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002062default-server X - X X
2063default_backend X X X -
2064description - X X X
2065disabled X X X X
2066dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002067email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002068email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002069email-alert mailers X X X X
2070email-alert myhostname X X X X
2071email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002072enabled X X X X
2073errorfile X X X X
2074errorloc X X X X
2075errorloc302 X X X X
2076-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2077errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002078force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002079filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002080fullconn X - X X
2081grace X X X X
2082hash-type X - X X
2083http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002084http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002085http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002086http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002087http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002088http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002089http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002090id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002091ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002092load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002093log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002094log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002095log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002096log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002097max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002098maxconn X X X -
2099mode X X X X
2100monitor fail - X X -
2101monitor-net X X X -
2102monitor-uri X X X -
2103option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2104option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2105option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2106option allbackups (*) X - X X
2107option checkcache (*) X - X X
2108option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2109option contstats (*) X X X -
2110option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2111option dontlognull (*) X X X -
2112option forceclose (*) X X X X
2113-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2114option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002115option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002116option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002117option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002118option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002119option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002120option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01002121option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002122option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2123option httpchk X - X X
2124option httpclose (*) X X X X
2125option httplog X X X X
2126option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002127option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002128option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002129option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002130option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2131option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2132option logasap (*) X X X -
2133option mysql-check X - X X
2134option nolinger (*) X X X X
2135option originalto X X X X
2136option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002137option pgsql-check X - X X
2138option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002139option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002140option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002141option smtpchk X - X X
2142option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2143option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2144option splice-request (*) X X X X
2145option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002146option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002147option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2148option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2149-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002150option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002151option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2152option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2153option tcpka X X X X
2154option tcplog X X X X
2155option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002156external-check command X - X X
2157external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002158persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2159rate-limit sessions X X X -
2160redirect - X X X
2161redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2162redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2163reqadd - X X X
2164reqallow - X X X
2165reqdel - X X X
2166reqdeny - X X X
2167reqiallow - X X X
2168reqidel - X X X
2169reqideny - X X X
2170reqipass - X X X
2171reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002172reqitarpit - X X X
2173reqpass - X X X
2174reqrep - X X X
2175-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002176reqtarpit - X X X
2177retries X - X X
2178rspadd - X X X
2179rspdel - X X X
2180rspdeny - X X X
2181rspidel - X X X
2182rspideny - X X X
2183rspirep - X X X
2184rsprep - X X X
2185server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002186server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002187server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002188source X - X X
2189srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002190stats admin - X X X
2191stats auth X X X X
2192stats enable X X X X
2193stats hide-version X X X X
2194stats http-request - X X X
2195stats realm X X X X
2196stats refresh X X X X
2197stats scope X X X X
2198stats show-desc X X X X
2199stats show-legends X X X X
2200stats show-node X X X X
2201stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002202-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2203stick match - - X X
2204stick on - - X X
2205stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002206stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002207stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002208tcp-check connect - - X X
2209tcp-check expect - - X X
2210tcp-check send - - X X
2211tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002212tcp-request connection - X X -
2213tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002214tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002215tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002216tcp-response content - - X X
2217tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002218timeout check X - X X
2219timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002220timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002221timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2222timeout connect X - X X
2223timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2224timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2225timeout http-request X X X X
2226timeout queue X - X X
2227timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002228timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002229timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2230timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002231timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002232transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002233unique-id-format X X X -
2234unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002235use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002236use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002237------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2238 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002239
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022414.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2242---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002243
2244This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2245
2246
2247acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2248 Declare or complete an access list.
2249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2250 no | yes | yes | yes
2251 Example:
2252 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2253 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2254 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002256 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002257
2258
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002259appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2260 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002261 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2263 no | no | yes | yes
2264 Arguments :
2265 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2266 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2267
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002268 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002269 checked in each cookie value.
2270
2271 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2272 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2273 milliseconds.
2274
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002275 request-learn
2276 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2277 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2278 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2279 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2280 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2281 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2282
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002283 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2284 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2285 data following this prefix.
2286
2287 Example :
2288 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2289
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002290 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2291 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002292
2293 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2294 2 modes are currently supported :
2295 - path-parameters :
2296 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2297 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2298 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2299 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2300 - query-string :
2301 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2302 query string.
2303
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002304 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2305 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2306 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002308 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2309 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310
2311
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002312backlog <conns>
2313 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2315 yes | yes | yes | no
2316 Arguments :
2317 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2318 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002319 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002320
2321 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2322 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2323 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2324 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2325 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2326 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2327 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2328 backlog parameter.
2329
2330 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2331 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2332 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2333
2334 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2335
2336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002337balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002338balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002339 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2341 yes | no | yes | yes
2342 Arguments :
2343 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2344 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2345 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2346 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2347
2348 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2349 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2350 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2351 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002352 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002353 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002354 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2355 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2356 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2357 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2358 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2359 it, so that you don't worry.
2360
2361 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2362 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2363 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2364 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2365 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2366 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2367 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2368 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002370 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2371 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2372 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2373 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2374 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2375 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2376 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2377 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2378
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002379 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002380 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002381 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2382 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002383 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002384 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2385 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2386 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2387 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2388 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002389 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2390 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2391 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2392 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2393 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2394 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2397 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2398 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2399 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2400 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2401 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2402 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2403 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002404 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002405 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002406 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2407 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2408 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002409
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002410 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2411 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2412 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2413 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2414 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2415 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2416 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2417 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2418 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2419 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2420 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2421 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002422
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002423 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002424 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2425 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2426 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2427 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2428 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2429 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2430 URIs start with a leading "/".
2431
2432 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2433 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2434 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2435 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2436
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002437 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002438 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2439
2440 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002441 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2442 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002443 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2444 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2445 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2446 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002447 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002448 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2449 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002450
2451 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2452 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2453 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2454 server will receive the request.
2455
2456 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2457 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2458 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2459 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2460 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002461 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2462 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2463 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002464
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002465 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2466 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2467 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2468 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2469 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002471 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002472 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2473 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2474 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2475
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002476 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2477 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2478 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2479
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002480 random A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
2481 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2482 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2483 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2484 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
2485 or removed. The hash-balance-factor directive can be used to
2486 further improve fairness of the load balancing, especially
2487 in situations where servers show highly variable response
2488 times.
2489
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002490 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002491 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002492 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2493 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2494 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2495 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2496 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2497 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002498 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002499 used instead.
2500
2501 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2502 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2503 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2504 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2505
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002506 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2507 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2508 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2509
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002510 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002511
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002512 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002513 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2514 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002515
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002516 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2517 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2518 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519
2520 Examples :
2521 balance roundrobin
2522 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002523 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002524 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2525 balance hdr(host)
2526 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002527
2528 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2529 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2530
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002531 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002532 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2533 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2534 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2535 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2536
2537 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2538 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2539 defaults to 16 kB.
2540
2541 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2542 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2543
2544 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2545 Round Robin.
2546
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002547 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002548 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2549 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2550 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2551
2552 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2553
2554 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002555 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002556 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2557 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2558 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002559
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002560 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561
2562
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002563bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2564bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002565 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2567 no | yes | yes | no
2568 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002569 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2570 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2571 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2572 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002573 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002574 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2575 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2576 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2577 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2578 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2579 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2580 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002581 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2582 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2583 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2584 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2585 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2586 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2587 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002588 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2589 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2590 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002591 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2592 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2593 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2594 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002595 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2596 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2597 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002598
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002599 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2600 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002601 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2602 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2603 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002604 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2605 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2606 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2607 the range.
2608
2609 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2610 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2611 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2612 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2613 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2614 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2615 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002616 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002617 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002619 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002620 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002621 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2622 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2623 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2624 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2625 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2626 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2627
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002628 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2629 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2630 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2631 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002633 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2634 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2635 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2636 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2637 in a frontend.
2638
2639 Example :
2640 listen http_proxy
2641 bind :80,:443
2642 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002643 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002644
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002645 listen http_https_proxy
2646 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002647 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002648
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002649 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2650 bind ipv6@:80
2651 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2652 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2653
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002654 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002655 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002656
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002657 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2658 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2659 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2660 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2661 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2662
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002663 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002664 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002665
2666
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002667bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002668 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2670 yes | yes | yes | yes
2671 Arguments :
2672 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2673 may be used to override a default value.
2674
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002675 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002676 option may be combined with other numbers.
2677
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002678 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002679 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2680 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2681 missing from all processes.
2682
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002683 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002684 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002685 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2686 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2687 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2688 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2689 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002690 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002691
2692 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2693 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2694 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2695 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2696 and 'even' instances.
2697
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002698 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2699 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2700 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2701 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002702
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002703 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2704 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2705
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002706 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2707 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2708 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2709
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002710 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2711 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2712
2713 Example :
2714 listen app_ip1
2715 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002716 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002717
2718 listen app_ip2
2719 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002720 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002721
2722 listen management
2723 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002724 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002725
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002726 listen management
2727 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2728 bind-process 1-4
2729
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002730 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002731
2732
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002733block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2736 no | yes | yes | yes
2737
2738 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2739 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002740 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002741 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002743 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2744 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2745 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002747 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2748 "http-request deny" instead.
2749
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002750 Example:
2751 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2752 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2753 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002754 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2755 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2756 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002757
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002758 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2759 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2760 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761
2762capture cookie <name> len <length>
2763 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2765 no | yes | yes | no
2766 Arguments :
2767 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2768 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2769 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2770 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002771 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002772
2773 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2774 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2775 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2776 right if it exceeds <length>.
2777
2778 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2779 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2780 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2781 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2782
2783 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2784 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2785 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2786
2787 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2788 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2789 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002790 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2791 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2792 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002793
2794 Example:
2795 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2796
2797 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002798 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799
2800
2801capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002802 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2804 no | yes | yes | no
2805 Arguments :
2806 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002807 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2809 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2810 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2811
2812 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2813 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2814 it exceeds <length>.
2815
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002816 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2818 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002819 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2820 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2821 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2822 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002823 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002824 environments to find where the request came from.
2825
2826 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2827 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2828 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2829 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002831 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2832 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2833 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2834 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2835 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002836
2837 Example:
2838 capture request header Host len 15
2839 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002840 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002842 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002843 about logging.
2844
2845
2846capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002847 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2849 no | yes | yes | no
2850 Arguments :
2851 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002852 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002853 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2854 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2855 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2856
2857 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2858 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2859 it exceeds <length>.
2860
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002861 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002862 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2863 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2864 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002865 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2866 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2867 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2868 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002869
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002870 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2871 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2872 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2873 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2874 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875
2876 Example:
2877 capture response header Content-length len 9
2878 capture response header Location len 15
2879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002880 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881 about logging.
2882
2883
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002884clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002885 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2887 yes | yes | yes | no
2888 Arguments :
2889 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2890 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2891 as explained at the top of this document.
2892
2893 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2894 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2895 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2896 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2897 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2898 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2899 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2900 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002901 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002902 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002903 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002904
2905 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2906 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2907 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2908 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2909 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2910 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2911
2912 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2913 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2914
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002915 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2916 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002918compression algo <algorithm> ...
2919compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002920compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002921 Enable HTTP compression.
2922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2923 yes | yes | yes | yes
2924 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002925 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2926 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2927 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2928
2929 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002930 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2931 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2932 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002933
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002934 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002935 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002936
2937 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2938 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2939 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2940 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2941 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002942 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002943
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002944 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2945 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2946 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2947 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2948 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2949 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2950 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002951 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002952
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002953 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002954 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002955 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2956 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2957 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2958 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2959 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002960
2961 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2962 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2963 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2964 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2965 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002966 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2967 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2968 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2969 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2970 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002971 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2972 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002973
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002974 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002975 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2976 "Accept-Encoding" header
2977 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002978 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002979 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2980 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002981 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2982 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2983 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2984 "multipart"
2985 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2986 header
2987 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2988 and later
2989 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2990 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002991
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002992 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2993 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002994
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002995 Examples :
2996 compression algo gzip
2997 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002998
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002999
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003000contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003001 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3003 yes | no | yes | yes
3004 Arguments :
3005 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3006 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3007 as explained at the top of this document.
3008
3009 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003010 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003011 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003012 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003013 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3014 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3015 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3016
3017 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3018 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3019 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3020 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3021 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3022 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3023
3024 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3025 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3026 instead.
3027
3028 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3029 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3030
3031
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003032cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003033 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3034 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003035 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003036 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3038 yes | no | yes | yes
3039 Arguments :
3040 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3041 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3042 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3043 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3044 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3045 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003046 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003047 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3048 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3049
3050 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3051 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3052 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3053 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3054 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3055 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003056 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3057 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003058 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003059 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3060 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003061
3062 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003063 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003064
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003065 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003066 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3067 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003068 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003069 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3070 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3071 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3072 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3073 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3074 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3075 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003076
3077 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3078 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3079 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3080 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3081 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3082 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3083 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3084 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3085 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003086 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003087 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3088 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3089 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003091 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3092 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3093 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003094 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3095 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3096 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3097 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003098 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3099 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3100 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003101
3102 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3103 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3104 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3105 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3106 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3107 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3108 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3109 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3110 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3111
3112 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3113 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3114 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3115 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3116 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3117 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3118 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3119 persistence cookie in the cache.
3120 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3121
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003122 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3123 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3124 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3125 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3126 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003127 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003128 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3129 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3130 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3131 they logout.
3132
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003133 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3134 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3135 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3136 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3137
3138 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3139 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3140 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3141 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3142 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3143 this attribute.
3144
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003145 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003146 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003147 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3148 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3149 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3150 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3151 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3152 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003153
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003154 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3155 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3156 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3157 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3158 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3159 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3160 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3161 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003162 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003163 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3164 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3165 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3166 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3167 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3168 the site.
3169
3170 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3171 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3172 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3173 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3174 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3175 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3176 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3177 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3178 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3179 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3180 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3181 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3182 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003183 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003184 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3185 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3186
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003187 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3188 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3189 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3190 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3191 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3192 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3193
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003194 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3195 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3196 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3197 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003198
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003199 Examples :
3200 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3201 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3202 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003203 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003204
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003205 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003207
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003208declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3209 Declares a capture slot.
3210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3211 no | yes | yes | no
3212 Arguments:
3213 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3214
3215 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3216 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3217 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3218 for use in the response.
3219
3220 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003221 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003222 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3223
3224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003225default-server [param*]
3226 Change default options for a server in a backend
3227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3228 yes | no | yes | yes
3229 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003230 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3231 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3232 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3233 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003234
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003235 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003236 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3237
3238 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003239
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003241default_backend <backend>
3242 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3244 yes | yes | yes | no
3245 Arguments :
3246 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3247
3248 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3249 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3250 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3251 will catch all undetermined requests.
3252
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003253 Example :
3254
3255 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3256 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3257 default_backend dynamic
3258
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003259 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003261
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003262description <string>
3263 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3265 no | yes | yes | yes
3266 Arguments : string
3267
3268 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3269 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3270 it describes.
3271 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3272
3273
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003274disabled
3275 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3277 yes | yes | yes | yes
3278 Arguments : none
3279
3280 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3281 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3282 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3283 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3284 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3285 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3286 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3287
3288 See also : "enabled"
3289
3290
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003291dispatch <address>:<port>
3292 Set a default server address
3293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3294 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003295 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003296
3297 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3298 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3299 during start-up.
3300
3301 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3302 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3303 possible with normal servers.
3304
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003305 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003306 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3307 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3308 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3309 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3310
3311 See also : "server"
3312
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003313
3314dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3315 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3317 yes | no | yes | yes
3318 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3319
3320 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003322 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3323 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003324 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003325 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003326
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003327enabled
3328 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3330 yes | yes | yes | yes
3331 Arguments : none
3332
3333 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3334 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3335
3336 See also : "disabled"
3337
3338
3339errorfile <code> <file>
3340 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3342 yes | yes | yes | yes
3343 Arguments :
3344 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003345 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3346 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003347
3348 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003349 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003350 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003351 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3352 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003353
3354 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3355 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3356 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3357
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003358 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3359
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003360 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3361 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3362 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3363 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3364
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003365 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3366 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003367 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003368 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3369 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3370 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003372 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3373 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3374 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003375 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003376 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3377
3378 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3379
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003380 Example :
3381 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003382 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003383 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3384 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3385
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003386
3387errorloc <code> <url>
3388errorloc302 <code> <url>
3389 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3391 yes | yes | yes | yes
3392 Arguments :
3393 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003394 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3395 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003396
3397 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3398 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3399 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3400 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003401 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003402
3403 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3404 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3405 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3406
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003407 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3408
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003409 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3410 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3411 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3412 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003413 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003414 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3415 request.
3416
3417 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3418
3419
3420errorloc303 <code> <url>
3421 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3423 yes | yes | yes | yes
3424 Arguments :
3425 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003426 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3427 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003428
3429 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3430 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3431 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3432 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003433 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003434
3435 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3436 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3437 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3438
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003439 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3440
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003441 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3442 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3443 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3444 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003445 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003446
3447 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3448
3449
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003450email-alert from <emailaddr>
3451 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003452 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003453 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3454 yes | yes | yes | yes
3455
3456 Arguments :
3457
3458 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3459
3460 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3461 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3462
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003463 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003464 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3465 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003466
3467
3468email-alert level <level>
3469 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3470 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3472 yes | yes | yes | yes
3473
3474 Arguments :
3475
3476 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3477 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3478 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3479
3480 By default level is alert
3481
3482 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3483 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3484 for the proxy.
3485
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003486 Alerts are sent when :
3487
3488 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3489 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3490 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3491 is notice or lower
3492 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3493 and a health check status update occurs
3494
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003495 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3496 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003497 section 3.6 about mailers.
3498
3499
3500email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3501 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3502 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3503 yes | yes | yes | yes
3504
3505 Arguments :
3506
3507 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3508
3509 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3510 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3511
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003512 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3513 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003514
3515
3516email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3517 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3518 mailers.
3519 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3520 yes | yes | yes | yes
3521
3522 Arguments :
3523
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003524 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003525
3526 By default the systems hostname is used.
3527
3528 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3529 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3530 for the proxy.
3531
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003532 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3533 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003534
3535
3536email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003537 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003538 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3539 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3540 yes | yes | yes | yes
3541
3542 Arguments :
3543
3544 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3545
3546 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3547 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3548
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003549 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003550 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3551
3552
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003553force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3554 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3555 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003556 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003557
3558 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3559 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3560 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3561 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3562 marked down for maintenance operations.
3563
3564 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3565 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3566 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3567 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3568 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3569 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3570 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3571 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3572 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3573
3574 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3575 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3576 is used.
3577
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003578 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003579 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003580
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003581
3582filter <name> [param*]
3583 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3585 no | yes | yes | yes
3586 Arguments :
3587 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3588 referenced in section 9.
3589
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003590 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003591 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003592 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3593 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003594
3595 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3596 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3597
3598 Example:
3599 listen
3600 bind *:80
3601
3602 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3603 filter compression
3604 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3605
3606 compression algo gzip
3607 compression offload
3608
3609 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3610
3611 See also : section 9.
3612
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003613
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003614fullconn <conns>
3615 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3617 yes | no | yes | yes
3618 Arguments :
3619 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3620 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3621
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003622 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003623 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003624 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003625 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3626 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3627 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3628 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3629 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003630 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003631
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003632 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3633 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003634 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3635 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3636 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003637
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003638 Example :
3639 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3640 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3641 # connections.
3642 backend dynamic
3643 fullconn 10000
3644 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3645 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3646
3647 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3648
3649
3650grace <time>
3651 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003653 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003654 Arguments :
3655 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3656 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3657 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3658
3659 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3660 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003661 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003662 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3663
3664 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3665 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3666 simplify it.
3667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003668
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003669hash-balance-factor <factor>
3670 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3672 yes | no | no | yes
3673 Arguments :
3674 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3675 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3676 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3677
3678 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3679 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3680 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3681 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3682 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3683 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3684 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3685
3686 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3687 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3688 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3689 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3690 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3691
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003692 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3693 consistent hashing mechanism.
3694
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003695 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3696
3697
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003698hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003699 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3701 yes | no | yes | yes
3702 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003703 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3704 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003705
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003706 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3707 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3708 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3709 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3710 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3711 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3712 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3713 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3714 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3715 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003716
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003717 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3718 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3719 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3720 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3721 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3722 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3723 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3724 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3725 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3726 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3727 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3728 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3729 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003730 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3731 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003732
3733 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3734
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003735 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003736 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3737 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3738 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003739 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3740 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3741 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003742
3743 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3744 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003745 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3746 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3747 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3748 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3749
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003750 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3751 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3752 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3753 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3754 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3755 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3756 parameter.
3757
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003758 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3759 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3760 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3761 used on strings.
3762
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003763 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3764
3765 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3766 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3767 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3768 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3769 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3770 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3771 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3772 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3773 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3774 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3775 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3776 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003777
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003778 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3779 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3780 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003781
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003782 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003783
3784
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003785http-check disable-on-404
3786 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003788 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003789 Arguments : none
3790
3791 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3792 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3793 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3794 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3795 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3796 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3797 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3798 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003799 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3800 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3801 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3802
3803 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3804
3805
3806http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003807 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003809 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003810 Arguments :
3811 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3812 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003813 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003814 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3815 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3816 details on the supported keywords.
3817
3818 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3819 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3820 with the usual backslash ('\').
3821
3822 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3823 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3824 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3825 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3826 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3827
3828 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003829 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003830 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3831 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3832 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3833
3834 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003835 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003836 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3837 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3838 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3839 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3840
3841 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003842 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003843 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3844 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3845 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3846 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3847 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003848 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003849 trace).
3850
3851 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003852 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003853 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3854 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3855 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3856 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3857 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003858 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003859
3860 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3861 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3862 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3863 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3864 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3865 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3866 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3867 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3868
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003869 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3870 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3871 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3872
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003873 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3874 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3875
3876 Examples :
3877 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003878 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003879
3880 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003881 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003882
3883 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003884 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003885
3886 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003887 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003888
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003889 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003890
3891
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003892http-check send-state
3893 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3895 yes | no | yes | yes
3896 Arguments : none
3897
3898 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3899 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3900 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3901 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3902 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3903
3904 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3905 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3906 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3907 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3908 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003909 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3910 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3911 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3912
3913 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3914 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3915 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3916
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003917 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3918 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3919 checked in multiple backends.
3920
3921 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3922 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3923
3924 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3925 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3926 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3927 one fails.
3928
3929 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3930 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3931 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3932
3933 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3934 server's queue.
3935
3936 Example of a header received by the application server :
3937 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3938 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3939
3940 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3941
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003942http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> | reject |
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003943 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003944 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003945 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003946 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003947 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3948 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003949 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3950 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04003951 set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003952 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3953 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3954 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003955 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003956 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003957 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003958 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003959 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01003960 sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003961 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003962 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01003963 send-spoe-group |
3964 cache-use
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003965 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003966 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003967 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3968
3969 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3970 no | yes | yes | yes
3971
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003972 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3973 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3974 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3975 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3976 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003977
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003978 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3979 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3980 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3981
3982 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003983 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3984 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3985 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3986 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003987
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003988 - "reject" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes
3989 the connection without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
3990 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an
3991 immediate connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
3992
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003993 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3994 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3995 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003996 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3997 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003998 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3999 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
4000 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4001 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
4002 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004003 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004004 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
4005 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004006
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004007 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
4008 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
4009 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
4010 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
4011 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
4012
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004013 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4014 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
4015 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01004016 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
4017 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004018
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004019 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4020 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4021 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004022 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004023 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
4024 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
4025 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4026 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4027
4028 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4029 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4030 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01004031 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
4032 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004033
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004034 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4035 <name>.
4036
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004037 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4038 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4039 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4040 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4041 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4042 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4043 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4044 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
4045
4046 Example:
4047
4048 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4049
4050 applied to:
4051
4052 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4053
4054 outputs:
4055
4056 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4057
4058 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
4059
4060 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4061 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4062 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4063 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4064 header.
4065
4066 Example:
4067
4068 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
4069
4070 applied to:
4071
4072 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
4073
4074 outputs:
4075
4076 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
4077
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004078 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
4079 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
4080 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
4081 it.
4082
4083 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
4084 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
4085 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
4086 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
4087 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
4088 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4089
4090 Example :
4091 # prepend the host name before the path
4092 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
4093
4094 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
4095 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
4096 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
4097 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
4098 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
4099 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
4100 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
4101 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4102
4103 Example :
4104 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4105 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
4106
4107 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
4108 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
4109 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
4110 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
4111 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
4112 "set-query".
4113
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004114 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4115 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4116 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4117 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4118 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4119 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4120 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4121 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4122
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004123 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4124 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4125 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4126 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4127 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4128 another equipment.
4129
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004130 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4131 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4132 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4133 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4134 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004135 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004136 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4137 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4138
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004139 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4140 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4141 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4142 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4143 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4144 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4145 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4146 admin privileges.
4147
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004148 - "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
4149 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to
4150 an integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
4151 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued
4152 requests are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
4153
4154 - "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
4155 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which
4156 converts to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this
4157 range will be truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by
4158 the priority class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given
4159 offset in milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
4160 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4161 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where
4162 the adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as
4163 highest priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value,
4164 where when combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
4165
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004166 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4167 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4168 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4169 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4170 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4171 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4172 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4173 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4174
4175 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4176 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4177 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4178 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4179 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4180 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4181
4182 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4183 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4184 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4185 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4186 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4187 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4188
4189 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4190 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4191 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4192 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4193 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4194 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4195 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4196 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4197 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4198
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004199 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004200 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4201 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4202 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4203 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4204 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4205 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4206 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4207 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4208 request header" for more information.
4209
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004210 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4211 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4212 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4213 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004214 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4215 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004216
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004217 - cache-use <name> :
4218 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4219
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004220 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4221 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02004222 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of
4223 counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set
4224 in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults
4225 to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The
4226 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004227 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4228 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4229 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4230 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4231 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4232 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4233 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4234
4235 These actions take one or two arguments :
4236 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4237 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004238 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004239 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4240
4241 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4242 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4243 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4244 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4245
4246 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4247 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4248 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4249 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4250 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4251 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4252 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4253 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4254
4255 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4256 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4257 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4258 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4259 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4260
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004261 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4262 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4263 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4264 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4265 continues.
4266
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004267 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4268 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4269 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4270 the actions evaluation continues.
4271
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004272 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
4273 Same as "sc-inc-gpc0" action above but for GPC1 counter.
4274
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004275 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4276 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4277 inline.
4278
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004279 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4280 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004281 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004282 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4283 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004284 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004285 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004286 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004287 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4288 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004289 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004290 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004291 and '_'.
4292
4293 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4294 followed by some converters.
4295
4296 Example:
4297
4298 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4299
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004300 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4301 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4302
4303 Example:
4304
4305 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4306
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004307 - set-src <expr> :
4308 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4309 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4310 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4311 source IP for privacy.
4312
4313 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4314 followed by some converters.
4315
4316 Example:
4317
4318 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4319 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4320
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004321 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4322 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004323
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004324 - set-src-port <expr> :
4325 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4326 expression.
4327
4328 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4329 followed by some converters.
4330
4331 Example:
4332
4333 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4334 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4335
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004336 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4337 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4338 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004339
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004340 - set-dst <expr> :
4341 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4342 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4343 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4344 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4345 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4346
4347 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4348 followed by some converters.
4349
4350 Example:
4351
4352 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4353 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4354
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004355 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4356 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4357
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004358 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4359 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4360 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4361 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4362
4363 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4364 followed by some converters.
4365
4366 Example:
4367
4368 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4369 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4370
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004371 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4372 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4373 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4374
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004375 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004376 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004377 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4378 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4379 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4380 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4381 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004382 down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact of using
4383 this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the client and
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004384 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4385 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4386 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4387 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4388 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4389 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4390 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4391
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004392
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004393 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4394 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4395 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4396
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004397 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4398 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4399 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4400 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4401 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4402 SPOE agent name must be used.
4403
4404 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4405
4406 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4407 configuration.
4408
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004409 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4410
4411 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4412 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004413 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4414 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4415
4416 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4417 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4418 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4419 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004420
4421 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004422 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4423 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4424 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004425
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004426 http-request allow if nagios
4427 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4428 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4429 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004430
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004431 Example:
4432 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004433 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004434
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004435 Example:
4436 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4437 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004438 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004439 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4440 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4441 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4442 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4443 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4444 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4445
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004446 Example:
4447 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4448 acl add path /addacl
4449 acl del path /delacl
4450
4451 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4452
4453 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4454 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4455
4456 Example:
4457 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4458 acl setmap path /setmap
4459 acl delmap path /delmap
4460
4461 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4462
4463 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4464 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4465
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004466 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4467 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004468
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004469http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004470 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004471 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004472 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4473 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004474 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004475 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4476 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4477 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4478 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004479 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004480 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004481 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004482 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004483 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004484 sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004485 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004486 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004487 send-spoe-group |
4488 cache-store
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004489 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004490 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004491 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4492
4493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4494 no | yes | yes | yes
4495
4496 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4497 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4498 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4499 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4500 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4501 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4502
4503 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4504 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4505 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4506 current section.
4507
4508 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4509 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4510 rules are evaluated.
4511
4512 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4513 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4514 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4515 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4516 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4517 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4518 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4519
4520 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4521 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4522 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4523 external users.
4524
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004525 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4526 <name>.
4527
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004528 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4529 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4530 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4531 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4532 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4533 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4534 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4535 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4536
4537 Example:
4538
4539 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4540
4541 applied to:
4542
4543 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4544
4545 outputs:
4546
4547 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4548
4549 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4550
4551 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4552 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4553 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4554 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4555 header.
4556
4557 Example:
4558
4559 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4560
4561 applied to:
4562
4563 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4564
4565 outputs:
4566
4567 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4568
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004569 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004570 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4571 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4572 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004573
4574 Example:
4575
4576 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4577 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004578 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4579 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004580
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004581 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4582 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4583 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4584 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4585 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4586 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4587 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4588 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4589
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004590 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4591 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4592 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4593 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4594 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4595 another equipment.
4596
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004597 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4598 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4599 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4600 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4601 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004602 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004603 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4604 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4605
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004606 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4607 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4608 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4609 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4610 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4611 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4612 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4613 admin privileges.
4614
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004615 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4616 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4617 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4618 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4619 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4620 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4621 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4622 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4623
4624 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4625 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4626 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4627 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4628 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4629 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4630
4631 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4632 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4633 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4634 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4635 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4636 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4637
4638 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4639 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4640 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4641 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4642 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4643 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4644 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4645 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4646 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4647
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004648 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4649 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4650 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4651 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4652 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4653 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4654 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4655 response header" for more information.
4656
4657 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4658 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4659 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4660 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4661 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004662 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4663 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004664
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004665 - cache-store <name> :
4666 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4667
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004668 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4669 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4670 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4671 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4672 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4673 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4674
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004675 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4676 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4677 inline.
4678
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004679 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4680 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004681 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004682 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4683 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004684 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004685 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004686 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004687 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4688 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004689 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004690 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4691 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004692
4693 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4694 followed by some converters.
4695
4696 Example:
4697
4698 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4699
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004700 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4701 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4702
4703 Example:
4704
4705 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4706
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004707 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4708 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4709 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4710 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004711 use of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4712 Layer 6 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004713 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4714
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004715 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4716 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4717 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4718 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4719 continues.
4720
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004721 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4722 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4723 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4724 the actions evaluation continues.
4725
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004726 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
4727 Same as "sc-inc-gpc0" action above but for GPC1 counter.
4728
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004729 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004730 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004731 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4732 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4733 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4734 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4735 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004736 down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact of using
4737 this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the client and
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004738 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4739 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4740 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4741 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4742 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4743 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4744 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4745
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004746 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4747 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4748 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4749 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4750 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4751 SPOE agent name must be used.
4752
4753 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4754
4755 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4756 configuration.
4757
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004758 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4759
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004760 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004761 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004762 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4763 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004764
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004765 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4766 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4767 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4768 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4769
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004770 Example:
4771 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4772
4773 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4774
4775 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4776 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4777
4778 Example:
4779 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4780
4781 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4782
4783 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4784 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4785
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004786 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4787 ACL usage.
4788
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004789
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004790http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4791 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4792
4793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4794 yes | no | yes | yes
4795
4796 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4797 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4798 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4799 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4800 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004801 This directive allows to tune this behavior.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004802
4803 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4804
4805 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4806 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4807 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4808 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4809 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4810 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4811 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4812 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4813 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4814 not checking any request past the first one.
4815
4816 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4817 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4818 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4819 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4820 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4821 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4822 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4823
4824 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4825 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4826 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4827 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4828 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4829 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4830 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4831 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4832 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4833 downsides of rare connection failures.
4834
4835 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4836 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4837 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4838 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4839 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4840 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004841 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004842 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4843 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4844 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4845 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4846 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4847
4848 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004849 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
4850 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
4851 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004852
4853 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004854 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004855
4856 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4857 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4858 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004859 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004860
4861 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4862 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4863 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4864
4865 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4866 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4867 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4868
4869 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4870
4871
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004872http-send-name-header [<header>]
4873 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4874
4875 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4876 yes | no | yes | yes
4877
4878 Arguments :
4879
4880 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4881
4882 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004883 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004884 is added with the header string proved.
4885
4886 See also : "server"
4887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004888id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004889 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4891 no | yes | yes | yes
4892 Arguments : none
4893
4894 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4895 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4896 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004897
4898
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004899ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4900 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4901 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004902 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004903
4904 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4905 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4906 and running).
4907
4908 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4909 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4910 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004911 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004912 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4913
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004914 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4915 "unless" condition is met.
4916
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004917 Example:
4918 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4919 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4920 ignore-persist if url_static
4921
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004922 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4923
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004924load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4925 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4926 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4927 yes | no | yes | yes
4928
4929 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4930 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4931 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004932 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004933 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4934 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4935 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4936 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4937
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004938 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004939 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004940 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004941
4942 Arguments:
4943 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4944 named "server-state-file".
4945
4946 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4947 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4948 name is used as a file name.
4949
4950 none don't load any stat for this backend
4951
4952 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004953 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4954 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4955 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004956 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004957 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004958
4959 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4960 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4961
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004962 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004963
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004964 global
4965 stats socket /tmp/socket
4966 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004967
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004968 defaults
4969 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004970
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004971 backend bk
4972 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4973 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004974
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004975
4976 Then one can run :
4977
4978 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4979
4980 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4981
4982 1
4983 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4984 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4985 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4986
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004987 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004988
4989 global
4990 stats socket /tmp/socket
4991 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4992
4993 defaults
4994 load-server-state-from-file local
4995
4996 backend bk
4997 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4998 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4999
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005000
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005001 Then one can run :
5002
5003 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5004
5005 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5006
5007 1
5008 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5009 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5010 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5011
5012 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5013 "show servers state"
5014
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005015
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005016log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005017log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005018no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005019 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5021 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005022
5023 Prefix :
5024 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5025 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5026 prefix does not allow arguments.
5027
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005028 Arguments :
5029 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5030 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5031 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5032 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5033 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5034 parameter.
5035
5036 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5037 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5038
5039 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5040 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5041 standard syslog port).
5042
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005043 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5044 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5045 standard syslog port).
5046
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005047 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5048 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5049 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005050 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005051
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005052 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5053 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005054
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005055 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5056 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5057 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5058 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5059 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5060 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5061 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5062 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5063 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5064 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005065 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005066
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005067 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5068
5069 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5070 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5071 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5072
5073 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5074 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5075 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005076 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5077 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5078 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5079 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5080 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005081
5082 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5083
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005084 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5085 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5086 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005087
5088 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5089 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5090 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5091 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5092
5093 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5094 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005095
5096 Example :
5097 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005098 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5099 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005100 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005101
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005102
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005103log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005104 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5105 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5106 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005107
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005108 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5109 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5110 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5111 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5112 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005113
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005114 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5115 "option httplog" directives.
5116
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005117log-format-sd <string>
5118 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5119 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5120 yes | yes | yes | no
5121
5122 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5123 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5124 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5125 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5126 which covers the log format string in depth.
5127
5128 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5129 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5130
5131 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5132 log format to "rfc5424".
5133
5134 Example :
5135 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5136
5137
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005138log-tag <string>
5139 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5140 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5141 yes | yes | yes | yes
5142
5143 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5144 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5145 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5146 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5147 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5148 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5149 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5150 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5151 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005152
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005153max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5154 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5155 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5156 yes | no | yes | yes
5157
5158 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5159 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5160 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5161 servers.
5162
5163 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5164 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5165 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5166 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5167 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005168 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005169 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5170 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5171 picking a different server.
5172
5173 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5174 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5175 even if they have to be queued.
5176
5177 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5178 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5179
5180
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005181maxconn <conns>
5182 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5184 yes | yes | yes | no
5185 Arguments :
5186 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5187 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5188 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5189 closes.
5190
5191 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5192 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5193 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5194 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005195 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5196 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5197 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5198 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005199
5200 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5201 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5202 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5203
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005204 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5205
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005206 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5207
5208
5209mode { tcp|http|health }
5210 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5212 yes | yes | yes | yes
5213 Arguments :
5214 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5215 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5216 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5217 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5218
5219 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5220 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5221 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5222 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5223 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5224
5225 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005226 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5227 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5228 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5229 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5230 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5231 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5232 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005233
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005234 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5235 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5236 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005237
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005238 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005239 defaults http_instances
5240 mode http
5241
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005242 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005243
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005244
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005245monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005246 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5248 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005249 Arguments :
5250 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5251 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005252 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005253 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5254 backend and its backup.
5255
5256 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5257 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5258 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5259 servers in a list of backends.
5260
5261 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5262 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5263 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5264 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5265 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5266 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5267 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005268 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5269 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005270
5271 Example:
5272 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005273 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005274 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5275 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5276 monitor-uri /site_alive
5277 monitor fail if site_dead
5278
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005279 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005280
5281
5282monitor-net <source>
5283 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5285 yes | yes | yes | no
5286 Arguments :
5287 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5288 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5289 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5290 followed by a mask.
5291
5292 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5293 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005294 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005295 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5296
5297 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5298 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5299 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5300 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005301 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5302 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5303 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005304
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005305 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5306 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5307 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5308 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5309 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5310 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005311
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005312 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5313 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005314
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005315 Example :
5316 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5317 frontend www
5318 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5319
5320 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5321
5322
5323monitor-uri <uri>
5324 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5326 yes | yes | yes | no
5327 Arguments :
5328 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5329 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5330
5331 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5332 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5333 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5334 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5335 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5336 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5337 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5338 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5339
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005340 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5341 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5342 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5343 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5344 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5345 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5346 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5347 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005348
5349 Example :
5350 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5351 frontend www
5352 mode http
5353 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5354
5355 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005357
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005358option abortonclose
5359no option abortonclose
5360 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5362 yes | no | yes | yes
5363 Arguments : none
5364
5365 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5366 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5367 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5368 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005369 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005370 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5371 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5372 encountered while delivering the response.
5373
5374 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5375 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5376 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5377 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5378 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5379 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005380 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005381 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005382 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005383 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5384 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5385 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5386
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005387 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5388 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005389 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5390 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5391 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5392 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5393 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5394 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005395 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005396
5397 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5398 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5399
5400 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5401
5402
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005403option accept-invalid-http-request
5404no option accept-invalid-http-request
5405 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5407 yes | yes | yes | no
5408 Arguments : none
5409
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005410 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005411 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005412 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005413 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5414 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5415 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5416 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5417 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005418 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5419 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5420 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5421 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005422 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005423 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005424 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5425 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5426 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005427
5428 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5429 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5430 been confirmed.
5431
5432 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5433 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005434 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5435 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005436 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5437
5438 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5439 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5440
5441 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5442 stats socket.
5443
5444
5445option accept-invalid-http-response
5446no option accept-invalid-http-response
5447 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5449 yes | no | yes | yes
5450 Arguments : none
5451
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005452 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005453 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005454 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005455 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5456 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5457 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5458 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5459 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005460 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5461 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5462 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005463
5464 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5465 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5466 been confirmed.
5467
5468 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5469 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5470 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5471 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5472
5473 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5474 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5475
5476 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5477 stats socket.
5478
5479
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005480option allbackups
5481no option allbackups
5482 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5484 yes | no | yes | yes
5485 Arguments : none
5486
5487 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5488 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5489 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5490 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5491 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5492 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5493 order between the backup servers anymore.
5494
5495 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5496 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5497
5498 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5499 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5500
5501
5502option checkcache
5503no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005504 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5506 yes | no | yes | yes
5507 Arguments : none
5508
5509 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5510 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005511 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005512 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5513 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005514 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005515
5516 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005517 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005518 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005519 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5520 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005521 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005522 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005523 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5524 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005525 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005526 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5527 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005528 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005529 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5530 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5531 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5532 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5533 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5534 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5535 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5536 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5537 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5538
5539 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005540 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005541 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005542 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005543 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5544
5545 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5546 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005547 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005548 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005549
5550 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5551 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5552
5553
5554option clitcpka
5555no option clitcpka
5556 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5558 yes | yes | yes | no
5559 Arguments : none
5560
5561 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5562 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005563 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005564 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5565
5566 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5567 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5568 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5569 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5570
5571 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5572 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5573 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5574 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5575 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5576
5577 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5578
5579 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5580 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5581 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5582
5583 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5584 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5585
5586 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5587
5588
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005589option contstats
5590 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5592 yes | yes | yes | no
5593 Arguments : none
5594
5595 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5596 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5597 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5598 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005599 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5600 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5601 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5602 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5603 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005604
5605
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005606option dontlog-normal
5607no option dontlog-normal
5608 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5610 yes | yes | yes | no
5611 Arguments : none
5612
5613 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5614 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5615 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5616 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5617 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5618 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5619 logged.
5620
5621 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5622 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5623 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005625 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005626 logging.
5627
5628
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005629option dontlognull
5630no option dontlognull
5631 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5633 yes | yes | yes | no
5634 Arguments : none
5635
5636 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5637 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5638 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5639 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5640 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5641 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005642 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5643 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5644 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005645
5646 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005647 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005648 would not be logged.
5649
5650 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5651 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5652
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005653 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5654 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005655
5656
5657option forceclose
5658no option forceclose
5659 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005661 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005662 Arguments : none
5663
5664 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5665 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5666 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5667 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5668 global session times in the logs.
5669
5670 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005671 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005672 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005673
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005674 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5675 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5676 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5677
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005678 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5679 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005680
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005681 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5682 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5683
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005684 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005685
5686
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005687option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005688 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5690 yes | yes | yes | yes
5691 Arguments :
5692 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5693 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005694 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005695 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005696
5697 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5698 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5699 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5700 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5701 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5702 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5703 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005704 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5705 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5706 possible that the client has already brought one.
5707
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005708 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005709 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005710 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005711 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005712 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005713 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005714
5715 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5716 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5717 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5718 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5719 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5720 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5721 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5722
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005723 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5724 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5725 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5726 are under the control of the end-user.
5727
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005728 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005729 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5730 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005731 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5732 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5733 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005734
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005735 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005736 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5737 frontend www
5738 mode http
5739 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5740
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005741 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5742 backend www
5743 mode http
5744 option forwardfor header X-Client
5745
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005746 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005747 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005748
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005749
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005750option http-buffer-request
5751no option http-buffer-request
5752 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5754 yes | yes | yes | yes
5755 Arguments : none
5756
5757 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5758 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5759 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5760 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5761 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5762 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5763 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5764 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005765 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005766 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5767 default.
5768
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005769 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005770
5771
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005772option http-ignore-probes
5773no option http-ignore-probes
5774 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5776 yes | yes | yes | no
5777 Arguments : none
5778
5779 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5780 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5781 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5782 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5783 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5784 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5785 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5786 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5787 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005788 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5789 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005790 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5791
5792 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5793 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5794 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5795 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5796 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5797 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5798 are often the only way to detect them.
5799
5800 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5801 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5802
5803 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5804
5805
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005806option http-keep-alive
5807no option http-keep-alive
5808 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 yes | yes | yes | yes
5811 Arguments : none
5812
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005813 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5814 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5815 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5816 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5817 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5818 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5819 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5820
5821 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5822 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005823 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5824 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5825 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5826 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5827 situations where this option may be useful :
5828
5829 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005830 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005831
5832 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5833 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5834
5835 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5836 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5837 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5838 request.
5839
5840 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5841 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005842 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5843 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5844 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005845
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005846 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5847 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5848 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5849 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5850 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5851 not set.
5852
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005853 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5854 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005855 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005856 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005857
5858 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005859 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5860 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005861
5862
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005863option http-no-delay
5864no option http-no-delay
5865 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5867 yes | yes | yes | yes
5868 Arguments : none
5869
5870 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5871 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5872 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5873 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5874 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5875 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5876 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5877 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5878 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5879 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5880 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5881 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5882 affected.
5883
5884 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5885 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5886 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5887 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5888 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5889 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5890 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5891 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5892 latency environments.
5893
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005894 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5895
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005896
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005897option http-pretend-keepalive
5898no option http-pretend-keepalive
5899 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5901 yes | yes | yes | yes
5902 Arguments : none
5903
5904 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5905 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5906 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5907 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5908 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5909 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5910 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5911 consider the response complete.
5912
5913 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5914 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5915 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5916 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5917 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5918 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5919
5920 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5921 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5922 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5923 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5924 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5925 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5926 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5927
5928 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5929 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005930 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005931 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5932 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005933
5934 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5935 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5936
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005937 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5938 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005939
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005940
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005941option http-server-close
5942no option http-server-close
5943 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5945 yes | yes | yes | yes
5946 Arguments : none
5947
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005948 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5949 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5950 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5951 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5952 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5953 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5954 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005955 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005956 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5957 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5958 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005959 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005960 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5961 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5962 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5963 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005964
5965 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5966 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5967 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5968 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005969 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5970 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005971
5972 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5973 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005974 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5975 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005976 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5977 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005978
5979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5981
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005982 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005983 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5984 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005985
5986
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005987option http-tunnel
5988no option http-tunnel
5989 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5991 yes | yes | yes | yes
5992 Arguments : none
5993
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005994 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5995 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5996 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5997 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5998 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5999 "option http-tunnel".
6000
6001 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006002 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006003 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6004 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6005 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6006 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6007 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6008 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6009 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006010
6011 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6012 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6013
6014 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
6015 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
6016 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
6017
6018
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006019option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006020no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006021 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6023 yes | yes | yes | no
6024 Arguments : none
6025
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006026 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006027 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6028 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6029 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6030 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6031 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6032 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6033
6034 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6035 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006036 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6037 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6038 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006039
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006040 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6041 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6042 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6043 front of an existing proxy.
6044
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006045 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6046
6047 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
6048 http-server-close".
6049
6050
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006051option httpchk
6052option httpchk <uri>
6053option httpchk <method> <uri>
6054option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6055 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6057 yes | no | yes | yes
6058 Arguments :
6059 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6060 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6061 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6062 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6063 ones.
6064
6065 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6066 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6067 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6068
6069 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6070 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6071 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6072 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6073 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6074
6075 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6076 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6077 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6078 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6079 the lack of any response.
6080
6081 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6082
6083 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6084 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6085 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6086
6087 Examples :
6088 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6089 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6090 backend https_relay
6091 mode tcp
6092 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6093 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6094
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006095 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6096 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6097 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006098
6099
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006100option httpclose
6101no option httpclose
6102 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
6103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6104 yes | yes | yes | yes
6105 Arguments : none
6106
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006107 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6108 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6109 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6110 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006111 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006112 "option http-tunnel".
6113
6114 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
6115 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
6116 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
6117 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
6118 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
6119 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
6120 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
6121 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006122
6123 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006124 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01006125 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
6126 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
6127 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
6128 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
6129 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006130
6131 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6132 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006133 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
6134 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006135 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
6136 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006137
6138 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6139 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6140
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02006141 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
6142 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006143
6144
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006145option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006146 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006148 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006149 Arguments :
6150 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6151 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6152 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006153 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006154 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006155
6156 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6157 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6158 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6159 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6160 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6161 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6162 ports.
6163
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006164 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6165 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006166
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006167 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006169 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006170
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006171
6172option http_proxy
6173no option http_proxy
6174 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6176 yes | yes | yes | yes
6177 Arguments : none
6178
6179 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6180 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6181 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6182 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6183 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6184
6185 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6186 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006187 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6188 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006189
6190 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6191 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6192
6193 Example :
6194 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6195 backend direct_forward
6196 option httpclose
6197 option http_proxy
6198
6199 See also : "option httpclose"
6200
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006201
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006202option independent-streams
6203no option independent-streams
6204 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6206 yes | yes | yes | yes
6207 Arguments : none
6208
6209 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6210 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6211 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6212 receive data or not.
6213
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006214 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006215 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6216 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6217 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6218 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6219 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6220 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6221 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6222 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6223 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6224 socket buffers.
6225
6226 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6227 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6228 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6229 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6230 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6231
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006232 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006233 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6234 deprecated.
6235
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006236 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006237
6238
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006239option ldap-check
6240 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6242 yes | no | yes | yes
6243 Arguments : none
6244
6245 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6246 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6247 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6248 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6249
6250 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6251 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6252
6253 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6254 configure it.
6255
6256 Example :
6257 option ldap-check
6258
6259 See also : "option httpchk"
6260
6261
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006262option external-check
6263 Use external processes for server health checks
6264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6265 yes | no | yes | yes
6266
6267 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6268 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6269 command".
6270
6271 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6272
6273 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6274
6275
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006276option log-health-checks
6277no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006278 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6280 yes | no | yes | yes
6281 Arguments : none
6282
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006283 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6284 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6285 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006286
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006287 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6288 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6289 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6290 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6291 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006293 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006294 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006295
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006296 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6297 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6298 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006299
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006300
6301option log-separate-errors
6302no option log-separate-errors
6303 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6305 yes | yes | yes | no
6306 Arguments : none
6307
6308 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6309 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6310 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6311 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6312 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6313 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6314 provides very important information.
6315
6316 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6317 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6318 error logs.
6319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006320 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006321 logging.
6322
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006323
6324option logasap
6325no option logasap
6326 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6328 yes | yes | yes | no
6329 Arguments : none
6330
6331 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6332 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6333 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6334 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6335 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6336 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6337 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006338 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006339 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6340 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6341
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006342 Examples :
6343 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6344 mode http
6345 option httplog
6346 option logasap
6347 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6348
6349 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6350 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6351 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6352 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006354 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006355 logging.
6356
6357
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006358option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006359 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6361 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006362 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006363 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6364 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006365 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006366
6367 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6368 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006369 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006370 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6371 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6372 in the MySQL table, like this :
6373
6374 USE mysql;
6375 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6376 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6377
6378 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006379 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006380 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6381 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6382 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6383 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6384 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6385 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6386 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6387
6388 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6389 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006390
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006391 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006392
6393 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6394 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6395 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6396 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006397 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6398 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006399
6400 See also: "option httpchk"
6401
6402
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006403option nolinger
6404no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006405 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006406 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6407 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006408 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006409
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006410 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006411 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6412 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6413 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6414 connections.
6415
6416 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6417 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6418 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6419 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6420 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6421 this too.
6422
6423 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6424 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6425 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6426
6427 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6428 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6429 for servers.
6430
6431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6433
6434
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006435option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6436 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6438 yes | yes | yes | yes
6439 Arguments :
6440 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6441 matching <network>
6442 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6443 header name.
6444
6445 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6446 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6447 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6448 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6449 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6450 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6451 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6452 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6453 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6454 possible that the client has already brought one.
6455
6456 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6457 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6458 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6459 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6460 header and requires different one.
6461
6462 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6463 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6464 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6465 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6466 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6467 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6468 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6469
6470 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6471 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6472 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6473 both are defined.
6474
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006475 Examples :
6476 # Original Destination address
6477 frontend www
6478 mode http
6479 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6480
6481 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6482 backend www
6483 mode http
6484 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6485
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006486 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6487 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006488
6489
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006490option persist
6491no option persist
6492 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6494 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006495 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006496
6497 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6498 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6499 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6500 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6501 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6502 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6503 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6504 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6505 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6506 redirected to another valid server.
6507
6508 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6509 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6510
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006511 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006512
6513
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006514option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6515 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6517 yes | no | yes | yes
6518 Arguments :
6519 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6520 PostgreSQL server.
6521
6522 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6523 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6524 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6525 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6526
6527 See also: "option httpchk"
6528
6529
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006530option prefer-last-server
6531no option prefer-last-server
6532 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6533 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6534 yes | no | yes | yes
6535 Arguments : none
6536
6537 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6538 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6539 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6540 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6541 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6542 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6543 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6544 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6545 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006546 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6547 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6548 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6549 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6550 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6551 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6552 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006553
6554 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6555 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6556
6557 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6558
6559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006560option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006561option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006562no option redispatch
6563 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6564 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6565 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006566 Arguments :
6567 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6568 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6569 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006570 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006571 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006572 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006573 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6574 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6575 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006577
6578 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6579 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6580 be able to access the service anymore.
6581
6582 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6583 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6584
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006585 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006586 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6587 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006589 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6590 "redisp" keywords.
6591
6592 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6593 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6594
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006595 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006596
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006597
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006598option redis-check
6599 Use redis health checks for server testing
6600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6601 yes | no | yes | yes
6602 Arguments : none
6603
6604 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6605 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6606 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6607 find the "+PONG" response message.
6608
6609 Example :
6610 option redis-check
6611
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006612 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006613
6614
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006615option smtpchk
6616option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6617 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6619 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006620 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006621 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006622 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006623 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6624
6625 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6626 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6627 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6628
6629 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6630 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6631 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6632 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6633 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6634 dead server.
6635
6636 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6637 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006638 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006639 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6640
6641 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6642 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6643 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6644 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006645 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006646
6647 Example :
6648 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6649
6650 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6651
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006653option socket-stats
6654no option socket-stats
6655
6656 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6658 yes | yes | yes | no
6659
6660 Arguments : none
6661
6662
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006663option splice-auto
6664no option splice-auto
6665 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6667 yes | yes | yes | yes
6668 Arguments : none
6669
6670 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6671 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006672 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006673 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006674 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006675 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6676 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6677 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6678 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6679
6680 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6681 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6682 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6683 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6684 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6685 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6686 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6687 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6688 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6689 keyword.
6690
6691 Example :
6692 option splice-auto
6693
6694 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6695 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6696
6697 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6698 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6699
6700
6701option splice-request
6702no option splice-request
6703 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6705 yes | yes | yes | yes
6706 Arguments : none
6707
6708 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006709 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006710 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6711 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6712 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6713 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6714
6715 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6716
6717 Example :
6718 option splice-request
6719
6720 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6721 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6722
6723 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6724 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6725
6726
6727option splice-response
6728no option splice-response
6729 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6731 yes | yes | yes | yes
6732 Arguments : none
6733
6734 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006735 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006736 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6737 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6738 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6739 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6740
6741 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6742
6743 Example :
6744 option splice-response
6745
6746 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6747 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6748
6749 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6750 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6751
6752
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006753option spop-check
6754 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6756 no | no | no | yes
6757 Arguments : none
6758
6759 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6760 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6761 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6762 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6763
6764 Example :
6765 option spop-check
6766
6767 See also : "option httpchk"
6768
6769
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006770option srvtcpka
6771no option srvtcpka
6772 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6774 yes | no | yes | yes
6775 Arguments : none
6776
6777 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6778 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006779 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006780 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6781
6782 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6783 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6784 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6785 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6786
6787 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6788 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6789 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6790 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6791 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6792
6793 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6794
6795 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6796 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6797 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6798
6799 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6800 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6801
6802 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6803
6804
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006805option ssl-hello-chk
6806 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6808 yes | no | yes | yes
6809 Arguments : none
6810
6811 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6812 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6813 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6814 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6815 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6816 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6817 hello message.
6818
6819 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6820 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6821 messages, which is appreciable.
6822
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006823 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6824 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6825 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006826
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006827 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6828
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006829
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006830option tcp-check
6831 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6832 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6833 yes | no | yes | yes
6834
6835 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6836 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6837
6838 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6839 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6840 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6841
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006842 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006843 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6844 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6845 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6846 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6847 only.
6848
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006849 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006850 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6851 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6852 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6853 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6854
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006855 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006856 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
6857 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006858 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006859 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6860 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6861 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6862 the respective protocols.
6863 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006864 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006865
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006866 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6867 script.
6868
6869 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6870 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6871 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6872 The "comment" is of course optional.
6873
6874
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006875 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006876 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006877 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006878 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006879
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006880 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006881 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006882 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006883
6884 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6885 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006886 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006887 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006888 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006889 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006890 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006891 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006892 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6893 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006894 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006895 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6896 tcp-check expect string +OK
6897
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006898 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006899 (send many headers before analyzing)
6900 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006901 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006902 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6903 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6904 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6905 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006906 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006907
6908
6909 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6910
6911
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006912option tcp-smart-accept
6913no option tcp-smart-accept
6914 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6916 yes | yes | yes | no
6917 Arguments : none
6918
6919 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6920 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6921 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6922 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6923 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6924 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6925
6926 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6927 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6928 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6929 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6930
6931 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6932 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6933 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006934 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006935
6936 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6937 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6938 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6939
6940 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6941 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6942 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6943
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006944 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6945
6946
6947option tcp-smart-connect
6948no option tcp-smart-connect
6949 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6951 yes | no | yes | yes
6952 Arguments : none
6953
6954 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6955 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6956 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6957 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6958 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6959
6960 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6961 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6962 complex.
6963
6964 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6965 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6966 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6967
6968 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6969 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6970
6971 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6972
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006973
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006974option tcpka
6975 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6977 yes | yes | yes | yes
6978 Arguments : none
6979
6980 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6981 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006982 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006983 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6984
6985 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6986 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6987 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6988 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6989
6990 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6991 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6992 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6993 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6994 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6995
6996 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6997
6998 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6999 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7000 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7001 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7002 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7003 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7004 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7005 backends.
7006
7007 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7008
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007009
7010option tcplog
7011 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007013 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007014 Arguments : none
7015
7016 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7017 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7018 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7019 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7020 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7021 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7022 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7023 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7024
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007025 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7026
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007027 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007028
7029
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007030option transparent
7031no option transparent
7032 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007034 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007035 Arguments : none
7036
7037 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7038 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7039 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7040 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7041 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7042 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7043 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7044 appropriate server.
7045
7046 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7047 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7048
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007049 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007050 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007051
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007052
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007053external-check command <command>
7054 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7056 yes | no | yes | yes
7057
7058 Arguments :
7059 <command> is the external command to run
7060
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007061 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7062
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007063 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007064
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007065 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7066 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7067 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7068 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7069 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7070 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007071
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007072 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7073
7074 Environment variables :
7075 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7076 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7077
7078 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7079
7080 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7081
7082 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7083 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7084 for a UNIX socket).
7085
7086 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7087
7088 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7089
7090 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7091
7092 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7093
7094 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7095
7096 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7097 socket).
7098
7099 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7100 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7101
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007102 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7103 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7104 failed.
7105
7106 Example :
7107 external-check command /bin/true
7108
7109 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7110
7111
7112external-check path <path>
7113 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7115 yes | no | yes | yes
7116
7117 Arguments :
7118 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7119
7120 The default path is "".
7121
7122 Example :
7123 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7124
7125 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7126 "external-check command"
7127
7128
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007129persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007130persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007131 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7133 yes | no | yes | yes
7134 Arguments :
7135 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007136 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7137 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007138
7139 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7140 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007141 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007142 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7143 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7144 forwarded to this server.
7145
7146 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7147 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7148 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007149 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007150 a single "listen" section.
7151
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007152 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7153 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7154 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7155
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007156 Example :
7157 listen tse-farm
7158 bind :3389
7159 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7160 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7161 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7162 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7163 persist rdp-cookie
7164 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007165 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007166 balance rdp-cookie
7167 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7168 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7169
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007170 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7171 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007172
7173
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007174rate-limit sessions <rate>
7175 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7177 yes | yes | yes | no
7178 Arguments :
7179 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7180 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7181
7182 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7183 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7184 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7185 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7186 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7187 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7188
7189 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7190 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7191 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7192 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7193
7194 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7195 listen smtp
7196 mode tcp
7197 bind :25
7198 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007199 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007200
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007201 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7202 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7203 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007204
7205 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7206
7207
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007208redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7209redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7210redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007211 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7213 no | yes | yes | yes
7214
7215 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007216 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007217
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007218 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007219 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007220 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7221 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7222 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007223
7224 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7225 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7226 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7227 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7228 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007229 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7230 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7231 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7232 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007233
7234 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7235 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7236 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7237 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7238 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7239 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007240 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007241 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007242 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7243 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7244 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007245
7246 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007247 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7248 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7249 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007250 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007251 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7252 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7253 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7254 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007255
7256 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007257 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007258
7259 - "drop-query"
7260 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7261 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7262 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7263 with a location-type redirect.
7264
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007265 - "append-slash"
7266 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7267 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7268 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7269 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7270
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007271 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7272 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7273 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7274 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7275 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7276 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7277 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7278
7279 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7280 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7281 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7282 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7283 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7284 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7285 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007286
7287 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7288 acl clear dst_port 80
7289 acl secure dst_port 8080
7290 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007291 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007292 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007293 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7294
7295 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007296 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7297 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7298 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007299 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007300
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007301 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7302 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7303 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7304
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007305 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007306 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007307
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007308 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007309 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7310 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7311 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007313 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007314
7315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007316redisp (deprecated)
7317redispatch (deprecated)
7318 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7320 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007321 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007322
7323 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7324 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7325 be able to access the service anymore.
7326
7327 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7328 redistribute them to a working server.
7329
7330 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7331 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7332 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007334 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7335 "option redispatch" instead.
7336
7337 See also : "option redispatch"
7338
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007339
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007340reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007341 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7343 no | yes | yes | yes
7344 Arguments :
7345 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7346 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007347 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007348
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007349 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7350 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7351
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007352 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7353 the last header of an HTTP request.
7354
7355 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7356 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7357 responses.
7358
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007359 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7360 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7361 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7362
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007363 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7364 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007365
7366
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007367reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7368reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007369 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7371 no | yes | yes | yes
7372 Arguments :
7373 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7374 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7375 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7376 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7377 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7378 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7379 ignores case.
7380
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007381 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7382 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7383
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007384 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7385 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7386 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7387 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007388 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007389
7390 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7391 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7392
7393 Example :
7394 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7395 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7396 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7397
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007398 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7399 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007400
7401
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007402reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7403reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007404 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7406 no | yes | yes | yes
7407 Arguments :
7408 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7409 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7410 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7411 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7412 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7413 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7414
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007415 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7416 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7417
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007418 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7419 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7420 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7421 next servers.
7422
7423 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7424 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7425 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7426
7427 Example :
7428 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7429 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7430 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7431
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007432 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7433 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007434
7435
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007436reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7437reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007438 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7440 no | yes | yes | yes
7441 Arguments :
7442 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7443 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7444 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7445 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7446 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7447 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7448 case.
7449
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007450 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7451 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7452
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007453 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7454 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7455 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7456 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007457 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007458
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007459 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007460 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007461 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007462
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007463 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7464 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7465
7466 Example :
7467 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7468 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7469 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7470
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007471 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7472 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007473
7474
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007475reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7476reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007477 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7479 no | yes | yes | yes
7480 Arguments :
7481 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7482 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7483 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7484 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7485 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7486 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7487 case.
7488
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007489 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7490 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7491
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007492 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7493 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7494 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7495 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7496
7497 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7498 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7499
7500 Example :
7501 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7502 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7503 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7504 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7505
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007506 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7507 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007508
7509
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007510reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7511reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007512 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7514 no | yes | yes | yes
7515 Arguments :
7516 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7517 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7518 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7519 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7520 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7521 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7522
7523 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7524 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7525 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7526 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007527 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007528
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007529 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7530 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7531
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007532 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7533 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7534 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7535
7536 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7537 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7538 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7539 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7540 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7541
7542 Example :
7543 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007544 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007545 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7546 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7547
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007548 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7549 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007550
7551
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007552reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7553reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007554 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7556 no | yes | yes | yes
7557 Arguments :
7558 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7559 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7560 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7561 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7562 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7563 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7564 ignores case.
7565
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007566 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7567 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7568
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007569 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7570 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007571 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7572 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7573 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007574 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7575 not set.
7576
7577 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7578 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7579 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7580 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7581 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7582
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007583 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007584 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007585 # block all others.
7586 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7587 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7588
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007589 # block bad guys
7590 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7591 reqitarpit . if badguys
7592
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007593 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7594 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007595
7596
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007597retries <value>
7598 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7599 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7600 yes | no | yes | yes
7601 Arguments :
7602 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7603 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7604 default value is 3.
7605
7606 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7607 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7608 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7609
7610 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007611 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7612 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007613
7614 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7615 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7616
7617 See also : "option redispatch"
7618
7619
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007620rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007621 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7623 no | yes | yes | yes
7624 Arguments :
7625 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7626 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007627 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007628
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007629 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7630 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7631
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007632 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7633 the last header of an HTTP response.
7634
7635 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7636 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7637 responses.
7638
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007639 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7640 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007641
7642
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007643rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7644rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007645 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7647 no | yes | yes | yes
7648 Arguments :
7649 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7650 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7651 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7652 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7653 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7654 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7655 ignores case.
7656
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007657 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7658 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7659
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007660 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7661 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007662 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007663 client.
7664
7665 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7666 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7667 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7668
7669 Example :
7670 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007671 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007672
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007673 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7674 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007675
7676
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007677rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7678rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007679 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7681 no | yes | yes | yes
7682 Arguments :
7683 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7684 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7685 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7686 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7687 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7688 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7689 ignores case.
7690
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007691 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7692 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7693
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007694 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7695 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7696 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7697 case-sensitive.
7698
7699 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007700 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7701 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7702 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007703
7704 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7705 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7706
7707 Example :
7708 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7709 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7710
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007711 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7712 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007713
7714
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007715rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7716rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007717 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7719 no | yes | yes | yes
7720 Arguments :
7721 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7722 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7723 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7724 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7725 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7726 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7727 ignores case.
7728
7729 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7730 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7731 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7732 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007733 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007734
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007735 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7736 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7737
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007738 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7739 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7740 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7741
7742 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7743 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7744 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7745 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7746 are not case-sensitive.
7747
7748 Example :
7749 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7750 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7751
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007752 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7753 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007754
7755
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007756server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007757 Declare a server in a backend
7758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7759 no | no | yes | yes
7760 Arguments :
7761 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007762 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007763 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007764
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007765 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7766 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7767 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7768 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007769 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7770 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7771 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7772 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7773 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007774 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7775 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7776 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7777 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7778 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7779 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7780 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007781 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007782 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7783 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7784 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7785 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7786 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7787 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007788 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7789 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007790 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7791 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007792
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007793 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007794 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7795 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7796 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7797 adding this value to the client's port.
7798
7799 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7800 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007801 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007802
7803 Examples :
7804 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7805 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007806 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007807 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7808 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7809 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007810
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007811 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7812 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7813 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7814 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7815 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7816
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007817 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7818 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007819
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007820server-state-file-name [<file>]
7821 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7822 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7823 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7824 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7825 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7826 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7827
7828 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7829 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7830
7831 global
7832 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7833
7834 backend bk
7835 load-server-state-from-file
7836
7837 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7838 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007839
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007840server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7841 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7842 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7844 no | no | yes | yes
7845
7846 Arguments:
7847 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7848
7849 <num | range>
7850 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7851 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7852 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7853 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7854
7855 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7856
7857 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7858
7859 <params*>
7860 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7861 keyword.
7862
7863 Examples:
7864 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7865 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7866 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7867
7868 # or
7869 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7870
7871 # would be equivalent to:
7872 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7873 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7874 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7875
7876
7877
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007878source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007879source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007880source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007881 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7883 yes | no | yes | yes
7884 Arguments :
7885 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7886 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007887
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007888 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007889 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7890 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7891 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7892 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7893 supported prefixes are :
7894 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7895 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7896 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007897 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007898 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7899 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007900
7901 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7902 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007903 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7904 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7905 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007906
7907 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7908 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7909 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7910 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7911 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7912 <addr>.
7913
7914 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7915 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7916 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7917 port.
7918
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007919 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7920 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7921 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7922 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007923 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007924 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7925 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7926 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7927 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7928 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7929 HTTP header.
7930
7931 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7932 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007933 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007934 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7935 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7936 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7937 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7938 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7939 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7940 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7941
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007942 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7943 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7944 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7945 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7946 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7947 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7948
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007949 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7950 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7951 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7952 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7953
7954 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7955 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7956 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7957 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7958 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7959 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7960
7961 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7962 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7963 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7964 there are two methods :
7965
7966 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7967 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7968 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7969 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7970 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7971 of the client ranges may be used.
7972
7973 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7974 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7975 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7976 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7977 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7978 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7979 same session.
7980
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007981 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7982 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7983 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007984 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007985
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007986 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7987
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007988 Examples :
7989 backend private
7990 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7991 source 192.168.1.200
7992
7993 backend transparent_ssl1
7994 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7995 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7996
7997 backend transparent_ssl2
7998 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7999 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8000 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8001
8002 backend transparent_ssl3
8003 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8004 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8005 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8006
8007 backend transparent_smtp
8008 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8009 # with Tproxy version 4.
8010 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8011
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008012 backend transparent_http
8013 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8014 # proxy.
8015 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008017 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008018 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008020
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008021srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8022 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8024 yes | no | yes | yes
8025 Arguments :
8026 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8027 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8028 as explained at the top of this document.
8029
8030 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8031 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8032 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8033 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8034 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8035 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8036 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8037
8038 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8039 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8040 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8041 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8042 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008043 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008044 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008045 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008046
8047 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8048 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8049 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8050 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8051 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8052 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8053
8054 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8055 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8056
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008057 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8058 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008059
8060
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008061stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8062 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008064 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008065
8066 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8067 matched.
8068
8069 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8070 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8071
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008072 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8073 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008074 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008075
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008076 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8077 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8078 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8079 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008080
8081 Example :
8082 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8083 backend stats_localhost
8084 stats enable
8085 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8086
8087 Example :
8088 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8089 backend stats_auth
8090 stats enable
8091 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8092 stats admin if TRUE
8093
8094 Example :
8095 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8096 userlist stats-auth
8097 group admin users admin
8098 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8099 group readonly users haproxy
8100 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8101
8102 backend stats_auth
8103 stats enable
8104 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8105 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8106 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8107 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8108
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008109 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8110 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8111 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008112
8113
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008114stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8115 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008117 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008118 Arguments :
8119 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8120
8121 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8122
8123 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8124 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8125 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8126 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8127 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8128 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8129
8130 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8131 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8132 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008133 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008134
8135 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8136 report using "stats scope".
8137
8138 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8139 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8140 unobvious parameters.
8141
8142 Example :
8143 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8144 backend public_www
8145 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8146 stats enable
8147 stats hide-version
8148 stats scope .
8149 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008150 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008151 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8152 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8153
8154 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8155 backend private_monitoring
8156 stats enable
8157 stats uri /admin?stats
8158 stats refresh 5s
8159
8160 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8161
8162
8163stats enable
8164 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008166 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008167 Arguments : none
8168
8169 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8170 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8171 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8172 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8173 - stats auth : no authentication
8174 - stats scope : no restriction
8175
8176 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8177 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8178 unobvious parameters.
8179
8180 Example :
8181 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8182 backend public_www
8183 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8184 stats enable
8185 stats hide-version
8186 stats scope .
8187 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008188 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008189 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8190 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8191
8192 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8193 backend private_monitoring
8194 stats enable
8195 stats uri /admin?stats
8196 stats refresh 5s
8197
8198 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8199
8200
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008201stats hide-version
8202 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008204 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008205 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008206
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008207 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8208 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8209 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8210 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8211 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8212 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008213
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008214 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8215 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8216 unobvious parameters.
8217
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008218 Example :
8219 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8220 backend public_www
8221 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008222 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008223 stats hide-version
8224 stats scope .
8225 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008226 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008227 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8228 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008229
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008230 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8231 backend private_monitoring
8232 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008233 stats uri /admin?stats
8234 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008235
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008236 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008237
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008238
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008239stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8240 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8241 Access control for statistics
8242
8243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8244 no | no | yes | yes
8245
8246 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8247 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8248 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8249 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8250 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8251 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8252
8253 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8254 instance.
8255
8256 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8257 about ACL usage.
8258
8259
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008260stats realm <realm>
8261 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008263 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008264 Arguments :
8265 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8266 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8267 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8268
8269 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8270 using a backslash ('\').
8271
8272 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8273 only related to authentication.
8274
8275 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8276 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8277 unobvious parameters.
8278
8279 Example :
8280 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8281 backend public_www
8282 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8283 stats enable
8284 stats hide-version
8285 stats scope .
8286 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008287 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008288 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8289 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8290
8291 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8292 backend private_monitoring
8293 stats enable
8294 stats uri /admin?stats
8295 stats refresh 5s
8296
8297 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8298
8299
8300stats refresh <delay>
8301 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008303 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008304 Arguments :
8305 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8306 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8307 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8308 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8309 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8310 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8311
8312 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8313 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8314 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8315 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8316
8317 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8318 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8319 unobvious parameters.
8320
8321 Example :
8322 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8323 backend public_www
8324 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8325 stats enable
8326 stats hide-version
8327 stats scope .
8328 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008329 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008330 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8331 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8332
8333 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8334 backend private_monitoring
8335 stats enable
8336 stats uri /admin?stats
8337 stats refresh 5s
8338
8339 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8340
8341
8342stats scope { <name> | "." }
8343 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008345 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008346 Arguments :
8347 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8348 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8349 section in which the statement appears.
8350
8351 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8352 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8353 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8354 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8355 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8356 exists.
8357
8358 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8359 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8360 unobvious parameters.
8361
8362 Example :
8363 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8364 backend public_www
8365 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8366 stats enable
8367 stats hide-version
8368 stats scope .
8369 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008370 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008371 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8372 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8373
8374 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8375 backend private_monitoring
8376 stats enable
8377 stats uri /admin?stats
8378 stats refresh 5s
8379
8380 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8381
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008382
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008383stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008384 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008386 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008387
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008388 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008389 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8390
8391 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8392 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8393
8394 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8395 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008396 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008397
8398 Example :
8399 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8400 backend private_monitoring
8401 stats enable
8402 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8403 stats uri /admin?stats
8404 stats refresh 5s
8405
8406 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8407 global section.
8408
8409
8410stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008411 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8413 yes | yes | yes | yes
8414 Arguments : none
8415
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008416 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008417 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8418 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8419 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8420 - IP (socket, server)
8421 - cookie (backend, server)
8422
8423 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8424 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008425 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008426
8427 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8428
8429
8430stats show-node [ <name> ]
8431 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008433 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008434 Arguments:
8435 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8436 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8437
8438 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8439 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008440 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008441
8442 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8443 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8444 unobvious parameters.
8445
8446 Example:
8447 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8448 backend private_monitoring
8449 stats enable
8450 stats show-node Europe-1
8451 stats uri /admin?stats
8452 stats refresh 5s
8453
8454 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8455 section.
8456
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008457
8458stats uri <prefix>
8459 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008461 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008462 Arguments :
8463 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8464 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8465 query string.
8466
8467 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8468 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8469 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8470 possible to reach it in the application.
8471
8472 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008473 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008474 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8475 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8476 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8477 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8478
8479 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8480 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8481 an address or a port to statistics only.
8482
8483 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8484 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8485 unobvious parameters.
8486
8487 Example :
8488 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8489 backend public_www
8490 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8491 stats enable
8492 stats hide-version
8493 stats scope .
8494 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008495 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008496 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8497 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8498
8499 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8500 backend private_monitoring
8501 stats enable
8502 stats uri /admin?stats
8503 stats refresh 5s
8504
8505 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8506
8507
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008508stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8509 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008511 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008512
8513 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008514 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008515 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008516 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008517 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8518
8519 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8520 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8521 the "stick-table" statement.
8522
8523 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8524 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8525 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8526 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8527 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8528
8529 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8530 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8531 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8532 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8533 transformation rules.
8534
8535 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8536 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8537 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8538 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8539 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8540 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8541 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8542
8543 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8544 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8545 ACL based conditions.
8546
8547 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8548 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8549 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8550 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8551
8552 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8553 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8554 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8555 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8556
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008557 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8558 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008559 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008560
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008561 Example :
8562 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8563 # last 30 minutes
8564 backend pop
8565 mode tcp
8566 balance roundrobin
8567 stick store-request src
8568 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8569 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8570 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8571
8572 backend smtp
8573 mode tcp
8574 balance roundrobin
8575 stick match src table pop
8576 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8577 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8578
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008579 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008580 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008581
8582
8583stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8584 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8586 no | no | yes | yes
8587
8588 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8589 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8590 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8591 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8592
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008593 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8594 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008595 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008596
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008597 Examples :
8598 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008599 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008600
8601 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8602 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8603 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8604
8605
8606 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8607 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8608 backend http
8609 mode http
8610 balance roundrobin
8611 stick on src table https
8612 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8613 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8614 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8615
8616 backend https
8617 mode tcp
8618 balance roundrobin
8619 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8620 stick on src
8621 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8622 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8623
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008624 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008625
8626
8627stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8628 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8630 no | no | yes | yes
8631
8632 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008633 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008634 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008635 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008636 server is selected.
8637
8638 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8639 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8640 the "stick-table" statement.
8641
8642 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8643 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8644 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8645 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8646 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8647 address.
8648
8649 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8650 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8651 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8652 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8653 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8654 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8655 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8656 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8657 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8658 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8659
8660 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8661 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8662 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8663 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8664 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8665 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8666 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8667
8668 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8669 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8670 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8671 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8672
8673 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8674 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8675 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8676 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8677 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8678 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008679 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8680 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8681 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8682 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8683 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8684 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008685
8686 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8687 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8688 the request.
8689
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008690 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8691 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008692 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008693
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008694 Example :
8695 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8696 # last 30 minutes
8697 backend pop
8698 mode tcp
8699 balance roundrobin
8700 stick store-request src
8701 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8702 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8703 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8704
8705 backend smtp
8706 mode tcp
8707 balance roundrobin
8708 stick match src table pop
8709 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8710 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8711
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008712 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008713 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008714
8715
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008716stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008717 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8718 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008719 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008721 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008722
8723 Arguments :
8724 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8725 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8726 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8727 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8728
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008729 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8730 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8731 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8732 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8733
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008734 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8735 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8736 instance.
8737
8738 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8739 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8740 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8741 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8742 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8743 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008744 to 32 characters.
8745
8746 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8747 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8748 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008749 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008750 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8751 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008752
8753 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008754 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8755 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008756 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8757 increase.
8758
8759 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008760 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8761 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8762 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008763
8764 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8765 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8766 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8767 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008768 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008769 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8770 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8771 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8772 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8773 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8774 parameter (see below).
8775
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008776 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8777 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8778 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8779 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8780 soft restart.
8781
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008782 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8783 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008784
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008785 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8786 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8787 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8788 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008789 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008790 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008791 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8792 if not expiration delay is specified.
8793
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008794 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8795 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8796 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8797 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008798 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8799 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8800 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8801 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8802 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8803 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8804 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8805 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8806 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8807 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8808 types and their arguments.
8809
8810 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8811 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8812 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8813 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8814
8815 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8816 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8817 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008818 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008819
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008820 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8821 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8822 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008823 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008824 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008825 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008826
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008827 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8828 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8829 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8830 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8831
8832 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8833 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8834 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8835 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8836 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8837 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8838
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008839 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8840 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8841 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8842 they were received.
8843
8844 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8845 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8846 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8847 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8848 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8849
8850 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8851 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8852 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8853 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8854 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8855
8856 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8857 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8858 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8859
8860 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8861 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8862 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8863 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8864 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8865
8866 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8867 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8868 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8869 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8870 the client side.
8871
8872 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8873 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8874 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8875 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8876 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8877 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8878 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8879
8880 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8881 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8882 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8883 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8884 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8885 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008886 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008887
8888 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8889 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8890 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8891 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8892 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8893 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8894
8895 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008896 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008897 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8898 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8899
8900 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8901 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8902 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8903 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8904 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8905 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8906 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8907 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8908 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8909 recommended for better fairness.
8910
8911 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008912 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008913 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8914 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8915
8916 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8917 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8918 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8919 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8920 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8921 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8922 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8923 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8924 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8925 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008926
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008927 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8928 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008929 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8930 reference it.
8931
8932 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8933 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008934 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8935 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8936 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008937
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008938 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8939 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8940 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8941 something that can be ignored.
8942
8943 Example:
8944 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8945 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8946 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8947 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8948
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008949 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008950 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008951
8952
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008953stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008954 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8956 no | no | yes | yes
8957
8958 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008959 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008960 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008961 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008962 server is selected.
8963
8964 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8965 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8966 the "stick-table" statement.
8967
8968 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8969 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8970 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8971 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8972
8973 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8974 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8975 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8976 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8977 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8978 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008979 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008980 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8981 rules.
8982
8983 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8984 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8985 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8986 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8987 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8988 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8989 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8990
8991 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8992 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8993 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8994 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8995
8996 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8997 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8998 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8999 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9000 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9001 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009002 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9003 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9004 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9005 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9006 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9007 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9008 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9009 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9010 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009011
9012 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9013
9014 Example :
9015 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9016 backend https
9017 mode tcp
9018 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009019 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009020 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009021
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009022 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9023 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9024
9025 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9026 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9027 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9028
9029 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9030 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009031
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009032 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9033 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9034 # at offset 44.
9035
9036 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9037 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9038
9039 # Learn on response if server hello.
9040 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009041
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009042 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9043 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9044
9045 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9046 extraction.
9047
9048
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009049tcp-check connect [params*]
9050 Opens a new connection
9051 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9052 no | no | yes | yes
9053
9054 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9055 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9056 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9057
9058 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9059 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9060 of the sequence.
9061
9062 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9063 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9064 do.
9065
9066 Parameters :
9067 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9068 use the TCP connection.
9069
9070 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9071 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9072 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9073
9074 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9075
9076 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9077
9078 Examples:
9079 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9080 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9081 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9082 option tcp-check
9083 tcp-check connect
9084 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9085 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9086 tcp-check send \r\n
9087 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9088 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9089 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9090 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9091 tcp-check send \r\n
9092 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9093 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9094
9095 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9096 option tcp-check
9097 tcp-check connect port 110
9098 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9099 tcp-check connect port 143
9100 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9101 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9102
9103 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9104
9105
9106tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009107 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009108 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9109 no | no | yes | yes
9110
9111 Arguments :
9112 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9113 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9114 binary.
9115 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9116 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9117 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9118
9119 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9120 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9121 with the usual backslash ('\').
9122 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009123 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009124 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9125 used upper or lower case.
9126
9127
9128 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9129
9130 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9131 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9132 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9133 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9134 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9135 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9136 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9137 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9138
9139 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9140 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9141 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9142 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9143 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9144 expression.
9145
9146 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9147 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9148 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9149 this exact hexadecimal string.
9150 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9151
9152 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9153 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9154 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9155 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9156 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9157 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9158 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9159 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9160 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9161 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9162 the null character.
9163
9164 Examples :
9165 # perform a POP check
9166 option tcp-check
9167 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9168
9169 # perform an IMAP check
9170 option tcp-check
9171 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9172
9173 # look for the redis master server
9174 option tcp-check
9175 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009176 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009177 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9178 tcp-check expect string role:master
9179 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9180 tcp-check expect string +OK
9181
9182
9183 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9184 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9185
9186
9187tcp-check send <data>
9188 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9189 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9190 no | no | yes | yes
9191
9192 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9193 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9194
9195 Examples :
9196 # look for the redis master server
9197 option tcp-check
9198 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9199 tcp-check expect string role:master
9200
9201 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9202 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9203
9204
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009205tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9206 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009207 tcp health check
9208 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9209 no | no | yes | yes
9210
9211 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9212 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009213 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009214 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9215 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9216 hexadecimal string.
9217 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9218
9219 Examples :
9220 # redis check in binary
9221 option tcp-check
9222 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9223 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9224
9225
9226 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9227 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9228
9229
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009230tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9231 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9233 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009234 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009235 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9236 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009237
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009238 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009239
9240 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9241 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009242 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9243 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9244 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9245 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9246 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9247 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009249 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9250 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9251 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9252 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009253
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009254 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009255 - accept :
9256 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9257 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9258 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009259
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009260 - reject :
9261 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9262 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9263 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9264 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9265 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9266 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9267 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9268 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9269 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9270 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9271 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009272 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009273
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009274 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9275 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9276 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9277 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9278 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9279 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9280 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9281 hosts.
9282
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009283 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9284 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9285 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9286 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9287 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9288 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9289 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9290 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9291
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009292 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9293 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9294 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9295 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9296 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9297 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9298 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9299 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9300 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009301 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9302 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009303
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009304 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009305 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009306 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9307 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9308 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9309 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9310 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9311 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9312 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9313 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9314 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9315 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9316 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9317 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009318
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009319 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009320 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009321 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009322 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009323 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9324 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9325 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009326
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009327 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9328 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9329 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9330 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009331
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009332 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9333 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9334 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9335 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9336 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009337 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9338 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9339 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9340 layer7 information is extracted.
9341
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009342 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9343 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9344 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9345 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9346 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009347
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009348 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9349 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9350 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9351 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9352
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009353 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9354 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9355 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9356 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9357
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009358 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9359 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9360 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9361 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9362 continues.
9363
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009364 - set-src <expr> :
9365 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9366 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9367 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9368 set-src"
9369
9370 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9371 followed by some converters.
9372
9373 Example:
9374
9375 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9376
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009377 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9378 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009379
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009380 - set-src-port <expr> :
9381 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9382 expression.
9383
9384 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9385 followed by some converters.
9386
9387 Example:
9388
9389 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9390
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009391 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9392 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9393 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009394
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009395 - set-dst <expr> :
9396 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9397 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9398 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9399 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9400 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9401
9402 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9403 followed by some converters.
9404
9405 Example:
9406
9407 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9408 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9409
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009410 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9411 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9412
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009413 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9414 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9415 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9416 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9417
9418
9419 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9420 followed by some converters.
9421
9422 Example:
9423
9424 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9425
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009426 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9427 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9428 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9429
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009430 - "silent-drop" :
9431 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009432 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009433 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9434 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9435 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9436 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9437 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009438 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9439 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009440 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9441 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009442 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009443 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9444 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9445 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9446 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9447
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009448 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9449 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9450 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009451
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009452 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9453 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9454 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009455
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009456 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009457 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009458 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009459
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009460 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9461 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9462 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009463
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009464 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009465 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9466 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009467
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009468 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9469
9470 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9471
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009472 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9473
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009474 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009475
9476
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009477tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9478 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009480 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009481 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009482 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9483 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009484
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009485 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009486
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009487 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009488 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9489 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9490 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9491 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009492
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009493 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9494 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9495 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9496 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009497 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9498 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9499 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9500 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9501 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9502 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009503 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009504 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009505
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009506 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9507 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9508 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9509 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009510
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009511 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009512 - accept : the request is accepted
9513 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9514 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009515 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009516 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009517 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009518 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009519 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009520 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009521 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009522 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009523 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009524
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009525 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9526 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009527
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009528 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9529 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9530 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9531 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9532 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9533 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009535 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009536 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9537 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009538
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009539 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009540 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9541 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9542 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9543 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009544 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9545 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9546 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009547
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009548 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009549 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9550 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9551 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009552
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009553 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009554 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9555 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009556
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009557 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9558 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009559 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009560 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9561 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009562 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009563 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009564 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009565 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9566 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009567 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009568 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9569 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009570
9571 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9572 followed by some converters.
9573
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009574 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9575 <var-name>.
9576
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009577 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9578 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9579 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9580 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9581 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9582
9583 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9584 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9585 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9586 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9587 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9588 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9589 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9590 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9591 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9592 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9593 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9594
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009595 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9596 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9597 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9598 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9599 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9600
9601 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9602
9603 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9604
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009605 Example:
9606
9607 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009608 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009609
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009610 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009611 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9612 # and reject everything else.
9613 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9614 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009615 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009616 tcp-request content reject
9617
9618 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009619 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9620 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9621 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009622 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009623
9624 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9625 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9626 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009627 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009628 tcp-request content reject
9629
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009630 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009631 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009632 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009633 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009634 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9635 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009636
9637 Example:
9638 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9639 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009640 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009641
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009642 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009643 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009644
9645 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009646 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009647 # protecting all our sites
9648 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009649 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9650 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009651 ...
9652 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9653
9654 backend http_dynamic
9655 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009656 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009657 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009658 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009659 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009660 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009661 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009663 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009664
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009665 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9666 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009667
9668
9669tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9670 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009672 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009673 Arguments :
9674 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9675 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9676 as explained at the top of this document.
9677
9678 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9679 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9680 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9681 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9682 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9683
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009684 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9685 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9686 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9687 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9688
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009689 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9690 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009691 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009692 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009693 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9694 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9695 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9696 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009697
9698 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9699 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9700 it pass through unaffected.
9701
9702 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9703 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9704 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009705 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009706 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9707 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009708 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9709 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9710 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009711
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009712 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009713 "timeout client".
9714
9715
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009716tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9717 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9719 no | no | yes | yes
9720 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009721 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9722 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009723
9724 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9725
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009726 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009727 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9728 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009729 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9730 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009731
9732 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9733
9734 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9735 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9736 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9737 inserted.
9738
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009739 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009740 - accept :
9741 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9742 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9743 the rules evaluation.
9744
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009745 - close :
9746 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9747 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9748 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9749 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9750 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9751 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009752 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009753 protocols.
9754
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009755 - reject :
9756 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9757 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009758 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009759
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009760 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9761 Sets a variable.
9762
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009763 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9764 Unsets a variable.
9765
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009766 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9767 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9768 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9769 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9770
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009771 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9772 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9773 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9774 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9775
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009776 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9777 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9778 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9779 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9780 continues.
9781
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009782 - "silent-drop" :
9783 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009784 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009785 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9786 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9787 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9788 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9789 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009790 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9791 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009792 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9793 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009794 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009795 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9796 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9797 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9798 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9799
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009800 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9801 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9802
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009803 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9804 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9805 for changing the default action to a reject.
9806
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009807 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9808 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9809 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9810 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009811 period.
9812
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009813 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9814 declared inline.
9815
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009816 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9817 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009818 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009819 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9820 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009821 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009822 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009823 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009824 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9825 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009826 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009827 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9828 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009829
9830 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9831 followed by some converters.
9832
9833 Example:
9834
9835 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9836
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009837 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9838 <var-name>.
9839
9840 Example:
9841
9842 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9843
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009844 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9845 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9846 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9847 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9848 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9849
9850 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9851
9852 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9853
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009854 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9855
9856 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9857
9858
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009859tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9860 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9862 no | yes | yes | no
9863 Arguments :
9864 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9865 below.
9866
9867 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9868
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009869 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009870 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9871 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9872 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9873 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9874 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9875 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9876 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009877 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009878 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9879 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9880 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9881 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9882 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9883 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9884 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9885 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9886 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9887 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9888 instead.
9889
9890 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9891 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9892 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9893 rules which may be inserted.
9894
9895 Several types of actions are supported :
9896 - accept : the request is accepted
9897 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9898 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9899 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009900 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009901 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9902 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009903 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009904 - silent-drop
9905
9906 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9907 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9908 sections for a complete description.
9909
9910 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9911 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9912 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9913
9914 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9915 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9916 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9917 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9918 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9919
9920 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9921 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9922
9923 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9924 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9925 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9926
9927 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9928 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9929 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9930
9931 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9932 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9933 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9934
9935 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9936 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9937 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9938
9939 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9940
9941 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9942
9943
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009944tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9945 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9947 no | no | yes | yes
9948 Arguments :
9949 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9950 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9951 as explained at the top of this document.
9952
9953 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9954
9955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009956timeout check <timeout>
9957 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9958 established.
9959
9960 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9961 yes | no | yes | yes
9962 Arguments:
9963 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9964 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9965 as explained at the top of this document.
9966
9967 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9968 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009969 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009970 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009971 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9972 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9973 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009974
9975 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9976 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9977
9978 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9979 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009980 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009981
9982 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9983 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9984 forget about it.
9985
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009986 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9987 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009988
9989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009990timeout client <timeout>
9991timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9992 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9994 yes | yes | yes | no
9995 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009996 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009997 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9998 as explained at the top of this document.
9999
10000 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10001 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10002 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010003 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10004 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10005 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10006 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010007 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10008 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10009 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010010 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010011 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010012 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10013 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010014 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10015 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010016
10017 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10018 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10019 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10020 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10021 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10022 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10023
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010024 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010025
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010026 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10027 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10028 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10029
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010030 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10031 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010032
10033
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010034timeout client-fin <timeout>
10035 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10037 yes | yes | yes | no
10038 Arguments :
10039 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10040 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10041 as explained at the top of this document.
10042
10043 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10044 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10045 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10046 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10047 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10048 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10049 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010050 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10051 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10052 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010053
10054 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10055 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10056 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10057
10058 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10059
10060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010061timeout connect <timeout>
10062timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10063 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10065 yes | no | yes | yes
10066 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010067 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010068 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10069 as explained at the top of this document.
10070
10071 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010072 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010073 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010074 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010075 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10076 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010077
10078 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10079 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10080 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10081 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10082 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10083 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10084
10085 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10086 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10087 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10088
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010089 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10090 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010091
10092
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010093timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10094 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10096 yes | yes | yes | yes
10097 Arguments :
10098 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10099 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10100 as explained at the top of this document.
10101
10102 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10103 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10104 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10105 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10106 once the request has started to present itself.
10107
10108 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10109 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10110 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10111 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10112 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10113
10114 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10115 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10116 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10117 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10118
10119 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10120 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010121 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010122 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10123 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010124 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010125
10126 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10127 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10128 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10129 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10130
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010131 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10132 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010133 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10134
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010135 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10136
10137
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010138timeout http-request <timeout>
10139 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010141 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010142 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010143 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010144 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10145 as explained at the top of this document.
10146
10147 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10148 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10149 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10150 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10151 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10152 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10153 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010154 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10155 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10156 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10157 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010158 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010159 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10160 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010161
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010162 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10163 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10164 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10165 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10166 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010167 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010168
10169 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10170 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010171 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010172 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10173 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10174
10175 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010176 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10177 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10178 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010179
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010180 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010181 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010182
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010183
10184timeout queue <timeout>
10185 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10187 yes | no | yes | yes
10188 Arguments :
10189 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10190 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10191 as explained at the top of this document.
10192
10193 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10194 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10195 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10196 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10197 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10198
10199 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10200 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10201 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10202 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10203
10204 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10205
10206
10207timeout server <timeout>
10208timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10209 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10211 yes | no | yes | yes
10212 Arguments :
10213 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10214 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10215 as explained at the top of this document.
10216
10217 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10218 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10219 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10220 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10221 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10222 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10223 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10224
10225 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10226 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10227 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10228 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10229 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010230 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010231 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010232 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10233 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010234 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10235 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010236
10237 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10238 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10239 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10240 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10241 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10242 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10243
10244 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10245 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10246 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10247
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010248 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010249
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010250
10251timeout server-fin <timeout>
10252 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10254 yes | no | yes | yes
10255 Arguments :
10256 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10257 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10258 as explained at the top of this document.
10259
10260 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10261 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10262 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10263 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10264 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10265 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10266 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10267 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10268 situations, it should not be needed.
10269
10270 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10271 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10272 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10273
10274 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10275
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010276
10277timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010278 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10280 yes | yes | yes | yes
10281 Arguments :
10282 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10283 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10284 as explained at the top of this document.
10285
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010286 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10287 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10288 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10289 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010290
10291 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10292 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10293 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10294 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010295 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010296
10297 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10298
10299
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010300timeout tunnel <timeout>
10301 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10303 yes | no | yes | yes
10304 Arguments :
10305 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10306 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10307 as explained at the top of this document.
10308
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010309 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010310 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10311 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10312 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010313 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10314 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010315 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10316 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10317 specified.
10318
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010319 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10320 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10321 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10322 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10323 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10324 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10325 state.
10326
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010327 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10328 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10329 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10330 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010331 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010332
10333 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10334 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10335 forget about it.
10336
10337 Example :
10338 defaults http
10339 option http-server-close
10340 timeout connect 5s
10341 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010342 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010343 timeout server 30s
10344 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10345
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010346 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010347
10348
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010349transparent (deprecated)
10350 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010352 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010353 Arguments : none
10354
10355 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10356 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10357 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10358 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10359 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10360 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10361 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10362 appropriate server.
10363
10364 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10365
10366 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10367 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10368
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010369 See also: "option transparent"
10370
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010371unique-id-format <string>
10372 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10374 yes | yes | yes | no
10375 Arguments :
10376 <string> is a log-format string.
10377
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010378 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10379 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10380 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10381 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010382
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010383 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10384 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10385 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10386 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10387 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10388 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10389 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10390 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010391
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010392 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10393 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010394
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010395 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010396
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010397 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010398
10399 will generate:
10400
10401 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10402
10403 See also: "unique-id-header"
10404
10405unique-id-header <name>
10406 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10408 yes | yes | yes | no
10409 Arguments :
10410 <name> is the name of the header.
10411
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010412 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10413 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010414
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010415 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010416
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010417 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010418 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10419
10420 will generate:
10421
10422 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10423
10424 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010425
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010426use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010427 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10429 no | yes | yes | no
10430 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010431 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10432 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010433
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010434 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10435 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010436
10437 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10438 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10439 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010440 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010441 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010442 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10443 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010444
10445 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10446 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10447 assign the backend.
10448
10449 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10450 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10451 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10452 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10453 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10454 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10455
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010456 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010457 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010458 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10459 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10460 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10461
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010462 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10463 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10464 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10465 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10466 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10467 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10468 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10469 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10470 cannot be forced from the request.
10471
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010472 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010473 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10474 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10475
10476 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10477 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010478
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010479
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010480use-server <server> if <condition>
10481use-server <server> unless <condition>
10482 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10484 no | no | yes | yes
10485 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010486 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010487
10488 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10489
10490 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10491 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10492 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10493
10494 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10495 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10496 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10497 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10498 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10499 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10500 matches will assign the server.
10501
10502 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10503 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10504 with the next rules until one matches.
10505
10506 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10507 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10508 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10509 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10510
10511 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10512 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10513 stripped.
10514
10515 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10516 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10517 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10518 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10519
10520 Example :
10521 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10522 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10523 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10524 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10525 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10526 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010527 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010528 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10529 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10530
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010531 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010532
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010533
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100105345. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010535--------------------------
10536
10537The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10538depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10539settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10540written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10541described in this section.
10542
10543
105445.1. Bind options
10545-----------------
10546
10547The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10548as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10549no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10550parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10551while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10552provided immediately after the setting name.
10553
10554The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10555
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010556accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10557 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10558 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10559 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10560 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10561 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10562 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10563 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10564 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10565 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010566 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10567 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10568 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010569
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010570accept-proxy
10571 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010572 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10573 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010574 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10575 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10576 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10577 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010578 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010579 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10580 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010581 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10582 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010583
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010584allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010585 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010586 due to security considerations.
10587
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010588alpn <protocols>
10589 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10590 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10591 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10592 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10593 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010594 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10595 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10596 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10597 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10598 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10599 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10600 preference, like below :
10601
10602 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010603
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010604backlog <backlog>
10605 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10606 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10607
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010608curves <curves>
10609 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10610 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10611 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10612 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10613 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10614 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10615
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010616ecdhe <named curve>
10617 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010618 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10619 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010620
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010621ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10623 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10624 client's certificate.
10625
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010626ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10627 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10628 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10629 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10630 error is ignored.
10631
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010632ca-sign-file <cafile>
10633 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10634 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10635 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10636 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10637 'generate-certificates' for details.
10638
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010639ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10641 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10642 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10643 'generate-certificates' for details.
10644
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010645ciphers <ciphers>
10646 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10647 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010648 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3. The format of the
10649 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for
10650 instance a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without
10651 quotes). Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list
10652 of suitable ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background
10653 information and recommendations see e.g.
10654 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10655 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10656 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10657
10658ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10659 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10660 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10661 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10662 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
10663 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section, and can be for instance a
10664 string such as
10665 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
10666 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
10667 the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010668
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010669crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10671 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10672 to verify client's certificate.
10673
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010674crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010675 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10676 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10677 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10678 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10679 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10680 file.
10681
10682 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10683 are loaded.
10684
10685 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010686 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010687 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10688 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10689 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10690 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010691 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10692 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010693 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010694
10695 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10696 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10697 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10698 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010699 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10700 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010701
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010702 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010703
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010704 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010705 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010706 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10707 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010708 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10709 clients).
10710
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010711 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10712 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10713 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10714 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10715 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10716 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10717 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10718 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10719 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10720 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10721 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10722 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10723 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10724
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010725 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10726 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10727 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10728 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10729 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10730
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010731 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10732 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10733 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10734 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010735
10736 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10737 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10738 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10739 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10740 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10741 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10742 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10743 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10744 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10745
10746 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10747
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010748 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010749 a cert bundle.
10750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010751 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010752 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10753 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10754 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10755 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10756 provide multi-cert support.
10757
10758 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10759
10760 Filename | CN | SAN
10761 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10762 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010763 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010764 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10765 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10766
10767 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10768 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10769 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10770 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010771 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10772 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10773 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010774
10775 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10776 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10777
10778 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10779 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10780 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10781
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010782crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010784 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010785 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010786 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010787
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010788crt-list <file>
10789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010790 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10791 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010792
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010793 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10794
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010795 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10796 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010797 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010798 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010799
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010800 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10801 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10802 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10803 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10804 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10805 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10806 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10807 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010808
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010809 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010810 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010811 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10812 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10813 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010814
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010815 crt-list file example:
10816 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010817 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010818 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010819 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010820
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010821defer-accept
10822 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10823 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10824 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010825 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010826 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10827 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10828 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10829 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10830 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10831 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10832 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10833
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010834expose-fd listeners
10835 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10836 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010837 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10838 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010839 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010840
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010841force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010842 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010843 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010844 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010845 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010846
10847force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010848 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010849 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010850 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010851
10852force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010853 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010854 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010855 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010856
10857force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010858 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010859 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010860 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010861
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010862force-tlsv13
10863 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10864 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010865 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010866
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010867generate-certificates
10868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10869 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10870 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10871 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10872 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10873 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10874 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10875 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10876 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10877 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10878 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10879
10880 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10881 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010882 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010883 certificate is used many times.
10884
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010885gid <gid>
10886 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10887 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10888 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10889 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10890 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10891
10892group <group>
10893 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10894 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10895 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10896 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10897 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10898
10899id <id>
10900 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10901 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10902 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10903 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10904
10905interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010906 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10907 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10908 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10909 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10910 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10911 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010912 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
10913 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
10914 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
10915 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
10916 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
10917 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010918
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010919level <level>
10920 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10921 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10922 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010923 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010924 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10925 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10926 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010927 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010928 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010929 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010930 all counters).
10931
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010932severity-output <format>
10933 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10934 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10935 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10936 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10937 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10938 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10939 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10940 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10941 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10942 rfc5424 convention.
10943
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010944maxconn <maxconn>
10945 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10946 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10947 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10948 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10949 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10950 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10951 eat all memory.
10952
10953mode <mode>
10954 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10955 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10956 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10957 UNIX sockets.
10958
10959mss <maxseg>
10960 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10961 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10962 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10963 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10964 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10965 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10966 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10967 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10968 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10969 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10970 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10971
10972name <name>
10973 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10974 page.
10975
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010976namespace <name>
10977 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10978 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10979 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10980 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10981
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010982nice <nice>
10983 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10984 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10985 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10986 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10987 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10988 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10989 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10990 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10991 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10992 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10993 one for an RDP socket.
10994
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010995no-ca-names
10996 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10997 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10998
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010999no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011000 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011001 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011002 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011003 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011004 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11005 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011006
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011007no-tls-tickets
11008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11009 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11010 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011011 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11012 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011013
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011014no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011015 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011016 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011017 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011018 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011019 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11020 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011021
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011022no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011023 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011024 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011025 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011026 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011027 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11028 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011029
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011030no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011032 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011033 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011034 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011035 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11036 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011037
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011038no-tlsv13
11039 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11040 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11041 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11042 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011043 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11044 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011045
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011046npn <protocols>
11047 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11048 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11049 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11050 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011051 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011052 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11053 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11054 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11055 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11056 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011057
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011058prefer-client-ciphers
11059 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11060 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11061 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011062 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11063 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11064 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011065
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011066process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11067 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11068 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011069 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011070 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11071 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11072 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11073 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011074 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011075 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11076 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11077 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11078
11079 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11080
11081 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11082 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11083 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11084 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11085 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11086 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11087 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11088 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011089
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011090proto <name>
11091 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11092 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11093 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11094 in haproxy -vv.
11095 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11096 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
11097 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifing "proto
11098 h2" on the bind line.
11099
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011100ssl
11101 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011102 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011103 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11104 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011105 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11106 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011107
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011108ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11109 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11110 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11111 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11112
11113ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11114 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11115 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11116 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11117
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011118strict-sni
11119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11120 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11121 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11122 See the "crt" option for more information.
11123
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011124tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011125 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011126 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11127 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011128 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011129 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11130 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11131 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11132 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11133 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11134 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11135 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11136
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011137tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011138 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011139 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11140 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11141 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11142 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11143 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11144 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11145 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011146 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11147 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11148 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011149
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011150tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11151 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
11152 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
11153 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
11154 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
11155 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
11156 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
11157 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
11158 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
11159 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11160 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11161
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011162transparent
11163 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11164 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11165 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11166 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11167 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11168 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11169 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11170 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11171 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11172 so check for support with your vendor.
11173
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011174v4v6
11175 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11176 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11177 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11178 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011179 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011180
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011181v6only
11182 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11183 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11184 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011185 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11186 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011187
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011188uid <uid>
11189 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11190 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11191 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11192 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11193 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11194
11195user <user>
11196 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11197 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11198 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11199 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11200 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11201
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011202verify [none|optional|required]
11203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11204 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11205 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11206 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11207 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011208 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11209 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11210 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11211 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011212
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200112135.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011214------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011216The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11217which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11218arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11219settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11220after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11221Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11222address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011224 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011225 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011226
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011227Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11228keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011230The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011231
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011232addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011233 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011234 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11235 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11236 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11237 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11238 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011239
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011240agent-check
11241 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011242 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
11243 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
11244 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
11245 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011246
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011247 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011248 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011249 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11250 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11251 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011252
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011253 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11254 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11255 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11256 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11257 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011258
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011259 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011260 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011261
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011262 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11263 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11264 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011265
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011266 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11267 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11268 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011269
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011270 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11271 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11272 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11273 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11274 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011275 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011276 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011277
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011278 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11279 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011280
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011281 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11282 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11283 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11284 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11285 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11286 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11287 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11288 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11289 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011290
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011291 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11292 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011293 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11294 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11295 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011296 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011297
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011298 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011299 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011300
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011301agent-send <string>
11302 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11303 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11304 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11305 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11306 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11307
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011308agent-inter <delay>
11309 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11310 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11311
11312 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11313 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11314 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11315 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11316 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11317 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11318 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11319 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11320 of backends use the same servers.
11321
11322 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11323
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011324agent-addr <addr>
11325 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11326
11327 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11328 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11329 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11330 hostname, it will be resolved.
11331
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011332agent-port <port>
11333 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11334
11335 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011337backup
11338 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11339 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11340 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11341 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011342 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11343 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011344
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011345ca-file <cafile>
11346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11347 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11348 server's certificate.
11349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011350check
11351 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011352 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11353 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11354 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11355 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11356 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11357 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11358 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011359 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11360 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011361 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11362 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011363
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011364check-send-proxy
11365 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11366 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11367 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11368 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11369 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11370 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11371 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11372
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011373check-sni
11374 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11375 over SSL.
11376
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011377check-ssl
11378 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11379 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11380 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11381 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011382 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011383 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11384 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011385 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011386 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11387 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011388
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011389ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011390 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11391 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11392 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011393 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11394 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11395 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11396 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11397 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11398 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11399
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011400ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11401 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11402 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11403 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11404 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
11405 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section.
11406
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011407cookie <value>
11408 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11409 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11410 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11411 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11412 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11413 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11414 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11415
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011416crl-file <crlfile>
11417 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11418 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11419 to verify server's certificate.
11420
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011421crt <cert>
11422 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11423 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11424 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11425 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11426 certificate request.
11427
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011428disabled
11429 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11430 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11431 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11432 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11433 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011434 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011435
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011436enabled
11437 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11438 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11439 default value.
11440 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11441 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011442
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011443error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011444 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11445 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11446 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011448 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011450fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011451 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11452 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11453 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11454
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011455force-sslv3
11456 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11457 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011458 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011459 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011460
11461force-tlsv10
11462 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011463 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011464 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011465
11466force-tlsv11
11467 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011468 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011469 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011470
11471force-tlsv12
11472 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011473 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011474 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011475
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011476force-tlsv13
11477 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11478 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011479 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011481id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011482 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11483 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11484 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011485
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011486init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11487 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11488 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011489 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011490 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11491 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11492 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11493 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11494 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11495 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11496 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11497 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11498 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011499 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011500 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11501 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11502 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11503 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11504 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11505 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011506 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011507
11508 Example:
11509 defaults
11510 # never fail on address resolution
11511 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011513inter <delay>
11514fastinter <delay>
11515downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011516 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11517 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11518 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11519 between checks depending on the server state :
11520
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011521 Server state | Interval used
11522 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11523 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11524 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11525 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11526 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11527 or yet unchecked. |
11528 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11529 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11530 | "inter" otherwise.
11531 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011533 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11534 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11535 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11536 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011537 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11538 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11539 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11540 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11541 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011542
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011543maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011544 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11545 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11546 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11547 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11548 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11549 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11550 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11551 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011553maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011554 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11555 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11556 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11557 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11558 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11559 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11560 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011562minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011563 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11564 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11565 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11566 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11567 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11568 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011569 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011570 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011571
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011572namespace <name>
11573 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11574 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11575 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11576 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11577
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011578no-agent-check
11579 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11580 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11581 default value.
11582 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11583 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11584
11585no-backup
11586 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11587 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11588 default value.
11589 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11590 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11591
11592no-check
11593 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11594 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11595 default value.
11596 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11597 "default-server" "check" setting.
11598
11599no-check-ssl
11600 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11601 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11602 default value.
11603 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11604 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11605
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011606no-send-proxy
11607 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11608 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11609 default value.
11610 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11611 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11612
11613no-send-proxy-v2
11614 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11615 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11616 default value.
11617 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11618 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11619
11620no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11621 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11622 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11623 default value.
11624 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11625 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11626
11627no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11628 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11629 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11630 default value.
11631 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11632 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11633
11634no-ssl
11635 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11636 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11637 default value.
11638 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11639 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11640
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011641no-ssl-reuse
11642 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11643 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11644 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11645 and for paranoid users.
11646
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011647no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011648 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11649 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011650 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011651
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011652 Supported in default-server: No
11653
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011654no-tls-tickets
11655 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11656 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11657 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011658 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11659 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011660 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011661
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011662no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011663 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011664 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11665 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011666 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11667 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011668 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011669
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011670 Supported in default-server: No
11671
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011672no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011673 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011674 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11675 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011676 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11677 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011678 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011679
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011680 Supported in default-server: No
11681
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011682no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011683 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011684 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11685 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011686 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11687 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011688 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011689
11690 Supported in default-server: No
11691
11692no-tlsv13
11693 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11694 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11695 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11696 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11697 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011698 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011699
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011700 Supported in default-server: No
11701
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011702no-verifyhost
11703 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11704 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11705 default value.
11706 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11707 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011708
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011709non-stick
11710 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11711 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11712 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011714observe <mode>
11715 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11716 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11717 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11718 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11719 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11720 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011721 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011722
11723 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11724
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011725on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011726 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11727 Currently, four modes are available:
11728 - fastinter: force fastinter
11729 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11730 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11731 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11732 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11733
11734 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11735
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011736on-marked-down <action>
11737 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11738 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011739 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11740 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11741 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11742 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11743 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11744 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11745 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11746 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011747
11748 Actions are disabled by default
11749
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011750on-marked-up <action>
11751 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11752 Currently one action is available:
11753 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11754 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11755 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11756 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011757 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11758 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011759 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11760 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11761
11762 Actions are disabled by default
11763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011764port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011765 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11766 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11767 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11768 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11769 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11770 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11771
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011772proto <name>
11773
11774 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11775 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11776 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11777 reported in haproxy -vv.
11778 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11779 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011781redir <prefix>
11782 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11783 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11784 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11785 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11786 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11787 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11788 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11789 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011790 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011791 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011792 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11793 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11794 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11795 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11796
11797 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011799rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011800 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11801 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11802 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11803
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011804resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11805 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11806 server.
11807
11808 Available options:
11809
11810 * allow-dup-ip
11811 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11812 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11813 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11814 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11815 For such case, simply enable this option.
11816 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11817
11818 * prevent-dup-ip
11819 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11820 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11821 same fqdn.
11822 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11823
11824 Example:
11825 backend b_myapp
11826 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
11827 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11828 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11829
11830 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
11831 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
11832 it
11833 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
11834 different address
11835
11836 Default value: not set
11837
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011838resolve-prefer <family>
11839 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11840 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11841 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11842 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11843
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011844 Default value: ipv6
11845
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011846 Example:
11847
11848 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011849
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011850resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11851 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11852 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011853 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011854 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11855 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011856 configured network, another address is selected.
11857
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011858 Example:
11859
11860 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011861
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011862resolvers <id>
11863 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11864 hostname.
11865
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011866 Example:
11867
11868 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011869
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011870 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011871
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011872send-proxy
11873 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11874 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11875 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11876 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011877 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11878 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11879 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11880 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11881 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11882 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11883 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11884 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11885 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11886 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011887 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11888 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011889
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011890send-proxy-v2
11891 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11892 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11893 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11894 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011895 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11896 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11897 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11898 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011899
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011900proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
11901 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
11902 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010011903 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
11904 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010011905 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
11906 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010011907 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011908
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011909send-proxy-v2-ssl
11910 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11911 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11912 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11913 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11914 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11915 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11916 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011917 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11918 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011919
11920send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11921 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11922 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11923 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11924 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11925 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11926 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11927 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11928 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011929 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
11930 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011931
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011932slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011933 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11934 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11935 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11936 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11937 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11938 parameters :
11939
11940 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11941 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11942
11943 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11944 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11945 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11946 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11947
11948 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11949 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11950 seen as failed.
11951
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011952sni <expression>
11953 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11954 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11955 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11956 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011957 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11958 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011959 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11960 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011961
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011962source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011963source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011964source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011965 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11966 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11967 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11968 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11969
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011970 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11971 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11972 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11973 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11974 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11975 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11976 server.
11977
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011978 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11979 specifying the source address without port(s).
11980
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011981ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011982 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11983 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11984 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11985 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11986 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11987 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011988 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11989 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011990
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011991ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11992 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11993 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11994 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11995
11996ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11997 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11998 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11999 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12000
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012001ssl-reuse
12002 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12003 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12004 default value.
12005 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12006 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12007
12008stick
12009 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12010 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12011 default value.
12012 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12013 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012014
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012015tcp-ut <delay>
12016 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12017 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12018 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012019 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012020 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12021 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12022 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12023 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12024 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12025 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12026 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12027 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12028 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012030track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012031 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12032 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12033 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12034 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012035 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12036
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012037tls-tickets
12038 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12039 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12040 default value.
12041 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12042 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012043
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012044verify [none|required]
12045 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012046 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012047 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12048 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012049 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012050 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12051 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12052 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12053 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12054 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12055 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12056 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12057 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012058
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012059verifyhost <hostname>
12060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012061 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12062 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12063 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12064 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12065 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12066 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12067 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12068 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012069
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012070weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012071 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12072 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12073 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012074 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12075 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12076 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12077 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12078 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12079 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012080
12081
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200120825.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12083-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012084
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012085HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12086using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12087configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012088This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12089can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12090workload.
12091This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12092resolution at run time.
12093Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12094carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12095
12096
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200120975.3.1. Global overview
12098----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012099
12100As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12101different steps of the process life:
12102
12103 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12104 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12105 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12106
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012107 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12108 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012109
12110A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12111 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12112 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12113 resolution to know this new IP.
12114
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012115When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012116HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012117SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12118from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12119will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12120will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012121
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012122A few things important to notice:
12123 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12124 first valid response.
12125
12126 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12127 servers return an error.
12128
12129
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200121305.3.2. The resolvers section
12131----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012132
12133This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012134HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12135contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012136
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012137When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12138uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12139is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12140answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12141
12142When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012143used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012144
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012145 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12146 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12147 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012148
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012149 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12150 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012151
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012152 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12153 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12154 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012155
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012156For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12157following scenarios are possible:
12158
12159 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12160 ignored
12161
12162 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12163 applied
12164
12165 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12166 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12167
12168 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12169 retries the query with a new type
12170
12171 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12172 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012173
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012174As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12175a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012176<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012177
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012178
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012179resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012180 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012181
12182A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12183
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012184accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012185 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012186 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012187 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12188 by RFC 6891)
12189
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012190 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12191
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012192nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12193 DNS server description:
12194 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12195 <ip> : IP address of the server
12196 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12197
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012198parse-resolv-conf
12199 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12200 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12201 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12202
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012203hold <status> <period>
12204 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12205 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012206 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012207 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012208 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12209 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12210 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12211
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012212 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012213
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012214resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012215 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12216 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12217 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12218
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012219resolve_retries <nb>
12220 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12221 giving up.
12222 Default value: 3
12223
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012224 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12225 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12226 type.
12227
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012228timeout <event> <time>
12229 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12230 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12231 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012232 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12233 other time applied.
12234 Default value: 1s
12235 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12236 have been received.
12237 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012238 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12239 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12240
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012241 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012242
12243 resolvers mydns
12244 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12245 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012246 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012247 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012248 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012249 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012250 hold other 30s
12251 hold refused 30s
12252 hold nx 30s
12253 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012254 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012255 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012256
12257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122586. HTTP header manipulation
12259---------------------------
12260
12261In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12262response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12263request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12264which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012265against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012266
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012267If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12268to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12269but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12270HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12271stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12272because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12273a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12274still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012276This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12277in section 4.2 :
12278
12279 - reqadd <string>
12280 - reqallow <search>
12281 - reqiallow <search>
12282 - reqdel <search>
12283 - reqidel <search>
12284 - reqdeny <search>
12285 - reqideny <search>
12286 - reqpass <search>
12287 - reqipass <search>
12288 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12289 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12290 - reqtarpit <search>
12291 - reqitarpit <search>
12292 - rspadd <string>
12293 - rspdel <search>
12294 - rspidel <search>
12295 - rspdeny <search>
12296 - rspideny <search>
12297 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12298 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12299
12300With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12301is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12302parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12303prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12304Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12305
12306 \t for a tab
12307 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12308 \n for a new line (LF)
12309 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12310 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12311 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12312 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12313 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12314
12315The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12316portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12317above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12318regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
123199 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12320is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12321
12322The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12323after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12324
12325Notes related to these keywords :
12326---------------------------------
12327 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12328 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12329 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12330
12331 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12332 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12333 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12334
12335 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12336 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12337 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12338 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12339 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12340
12341 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12342 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12343 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12344 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12345 useless headers before adding new ones.
12346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012347 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012348 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12349
12350 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12351 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12352 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12353
12354 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12355 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012356 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012357
12358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123597. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12360----------------------------------
12361
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012362HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012363client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12364The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12365these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12366but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12367data called patterns.
12368
12369
123707.1. ACL basics
12371---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012372
12373The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12374content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12375from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12376simple :
12377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012378 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012379 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012380 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12381 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012383The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12384adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012385
12386In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012388 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012389
12390This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12391Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12392and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012393an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12394conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12395as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12396are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012397
12398ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12399'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12400which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12401
12402There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12403performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012405The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12406specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12407this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012408methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12409ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012410
12411Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12412 - boolean
12413 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12414 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12415 - string
12416 - data block
12417
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012418Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12419converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12420would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12421The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12422which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12423
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012424Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12425keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12426fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12427which are summarized in the table below :
12428
12429 +---------------------+-----------------+
12430 | Sample or converter | Default |
12431 | output type | matching method |
12432 +---------------------+-----------------+
12433 | boolean | bool |
12434 +---------------------+-----------------+
12435 | integer | int |
12436 +---------------------+-----------------+
12437 | ip | ip |
12438 +---------------------+-----------------+
12439 | string | str |
12440 +---------------------+-----------------+
12441 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12442 +---------------------+-----------------+
12443
12444Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12445matching method, see below.
12446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012447The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12448 - boolean
12449 - integer or integer range
12450 - IP address / network
12451 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12452 - regular expression
12453 - hex block
12454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012455The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12456
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012457 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12458 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012459 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012460 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012461 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012462 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012463 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012465The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12466read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12467if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12468lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12469will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12470beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12471a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12472lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12473exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12474
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012475The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12476parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12477ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12478a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12479check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12480
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012481The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12482socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12483file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012485Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12486loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12487
12488 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12489
12490In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12491the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12492case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12493as well.
12494
12495The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12496sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12497do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12498methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12499is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012500obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012501followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12502default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12503that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12504string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12505
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012506The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12507By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12508string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12509resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12510server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12511waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12512flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12513function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012515There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12516sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12517be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012518
12519 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12520 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012521 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12522 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12523 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12524 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012525
12526 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12527 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012528 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012529
12530 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012531 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012532
12533 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012534 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012535
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012536 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012537 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12538
12539 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12540 binary or string samples.
12541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012542 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12543 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012545 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12546 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12547 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012549 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12550 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012552 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12553 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012555 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12556 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012558 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12559 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012560 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012562 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12563 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12564 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012565
12566For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12567request, it is possible to do :
12568
12569 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12570
12571In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12572buffer, one would use the following acl :
12573
12574 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12575
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012576On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12577possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12578
12579 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012581All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12582criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12583method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12584to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12585criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12586the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012588If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012589the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12590For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012592 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12593 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12594 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12595 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012596
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012597
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012598The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12599types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12600combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12601brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12602default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012604 +-------------------------------------------------+
12605 | Input sample type |
12606 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012607 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012608 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12609 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12610 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012611 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012612 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012613 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012614 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012615 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012616 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012617 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012618 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012619 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012620 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012621 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012622 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012623 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012624 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012625 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012626 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012627 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012628 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012629 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012630 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012631 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012632 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12633 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12634 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012635
12636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126377.1.1. Matching booleans
12638------------------------
12639
12640In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12641Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12642When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12643that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12644
12645Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12646return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12647"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12648
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126507.1.2. Matching integers
12651------------------------
12652
12653Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12654enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12655to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12656
12657Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12658matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12659lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012660
12661For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12662unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12663representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12664
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012665As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12666two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12667instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12668ranges and operators.
12669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012670For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012671operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12672Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12673of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012675Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012676
12677 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12678 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12679 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12680 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12681 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012683For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012684
12685 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12686
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012687This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12688
12689 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12690
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126927.1.3. Matching strings
12693-----------------------
12694
12695String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12696different forms :
12697
12698 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012699 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012700
12701 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012702 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012703
12704 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12705 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12706
12707 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12708 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12709
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012710 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012711 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12712 matches.
12713
12714 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12715 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12716 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012717
12718String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12719exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12720characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12721string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12722to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012723before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012724
12725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127267.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12727---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012728
12729Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12730they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12731possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12732passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12733the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012734the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12735match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012736
12737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127387.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12739-------------------------------------
12740
12741It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12742not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12743a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12744to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12745digits may be used upper or lower case.
12746
12747Example :
12748 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12749 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12750
12751
127527.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12753---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012754
12755IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12756netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12757within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012758host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012759difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12760at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12761does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12762parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012763
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012764The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12765abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12766
12767 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12768 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12769 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12770 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12771 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12772 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12773 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12774 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12775
12776Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12777192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12778
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012779IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12780Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12781trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12782IPv6 patterns.
12783
12784HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12785following situations :
12786 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12787 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12788 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12789 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12790 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12791 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12792 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12793 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12794 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12795 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012797
127987.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12799----------------------------------
12800
12801Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12802combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12803
12804 - AND (implicit)
12805 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12806 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012808A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012810 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012812Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12813indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012815For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12816"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12817requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12818is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12819
12820 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012821 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12822 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12823 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012824
12825To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12826and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12827
12828 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12829 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12830 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12831 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12832
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012833 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012834 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12835 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12836 use_backend www if host_www
12837
12838It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12839expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12840be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12841the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12842
12843 The following rule :
12844
12845 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012846 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012847
12848 Can also be written that way :
12849
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012850 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012851
12852It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12853to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12854simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12855sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12856good use is the following :
12857
12858 With named ACLs :
12859
12860 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12861 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12862 monitor fail if site_dead
12863
12864 With anonymous ACLs :
12865
12866 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12867
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012868See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12869keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012870
12871
128727.3. Fetching samples
12873---------------------
12874
12875Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12876against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12877sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12878ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12879of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12880available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12881
12882This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12883Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12884compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12885deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12886
12887The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12888matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12889method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12890indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12891
12892As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12893when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12894mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12895the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12896ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12897
12898Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12899multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12900when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012901incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12902are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012903is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12904all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12905
12906Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12907 - name
12908 - name(arg1)
12909 - name(arg1,arg2)
12910
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012911
129127.3.1. Converters
12913-----------------
12914
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012915Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12916of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12917is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12918was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012919has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012920unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12921
12922These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12923sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12924the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012925support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012926
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012927A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12928support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12929supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12930(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12931bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012933The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012934
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001293551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12936 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12937 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12938 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12939 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12940 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12941
12942 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012943 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
12944 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000012945 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12946 frontend http-in
12947 bind *:8081
12948 default_backend servers
12949 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12950 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12951
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012952add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012953 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012954 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012955 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12956 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012957 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012958 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12959 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12960 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12961 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012962 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012963 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012964
12965and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012966 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012967 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012968 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12969 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012970 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012971 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12972 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12973 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12974 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012975 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012976 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012977
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012978b64dec
12979 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12980 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12981
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012982base64
12983 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012984 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012985 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12986
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012987bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012988 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012989 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012990 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012991 presence of a flag).
12992
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012993bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12994 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12995 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012996 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012997
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010012998concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
12999 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13000 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13001 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13002 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13003 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13004 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13005 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13006 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13007 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13008 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13009 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13010 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13011 delimitors.
13012
13013 Example:
13014 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13015 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13016 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13017 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13018
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013019cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013020 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13021 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013022
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013023crc32([<avalanche>])
13024 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13025 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13026 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13027 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13028 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13029 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13030 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13031 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13032 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13033 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013034 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13035
13036crc32c([<avalanche>])
13037 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13038 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13039 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13040 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13041 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13042 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13043 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13044 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013045
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013046da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013047 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13048 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13049 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13050 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013051 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013052 configuration language.
13053
13054 Example:
13055 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013056 bind *:8881
13057 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013058 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013059
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013060debug
13061 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13062 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13063 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13064
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013065div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013066 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13067 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013068 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013069 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13070 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013071 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013072 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13073 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13074 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13075 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013076 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013077 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013078
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013079djb2([<avalanche>])
13080 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13081 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13082 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13083 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13084 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13085 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13086 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013087 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13088 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013089
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013090even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013091 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013092 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13093
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013094field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13095 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13096 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13097 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13098 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13099 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13100 fields.
13101
13102 Example :
13103 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13104 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13105 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13106 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13107 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013108
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013109hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013110 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013111 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013112 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013113 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013114
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013115hex2i
13116 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13117 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13118
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013119http_date([<offset>])
13120 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13121 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13122 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13123 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13124 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13125 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013126
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013127in_table(<table>)
13128 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13129 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13130 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013131 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013132 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13133
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013134ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13135 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013136 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013137 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13138 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13139 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13140 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13141 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013142
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013143json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013144 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013145 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013146 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013147 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13148 of errors:
13149 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13150 bytes, ...)
13151 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13152 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13153
13154 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13155 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13156 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13157 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13158 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13159 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013160 - "ascii" : never fails;
13161 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13162 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013163 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013164 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013165 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13166 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13167
13168 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013169 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013170
13171 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013172 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013173 capture request header user-agent len 150
13174 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013175
13176 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13177 GET / HTTP/1.0
13178 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13179
13180 Output log:
13181 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13182
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013183language(<value>[,<default>])
13184 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13185 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13186 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13187 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13188 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13189 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13190 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13191 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13192 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013193 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013194 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13195 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013196
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013197 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013198
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013199 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13200 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013201
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013202 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13203 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13204 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13205 use_backend spanish if es
13206 use_backend french if fr
13207 use_backend english if en
13208 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013209
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013210length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013211 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13212 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13213 type. The result is of type integer.
13214
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013215lower
13216 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13217 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13218 type. The result is of type string.
13219
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013220ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13221 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13222 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13223 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13224 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13225 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13226 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13227
13228 Example :
13229
13230 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013231 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013232 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13233
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013234map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13235map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13236map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13237 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13238 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13239 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13240 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13241 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13242 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13243 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13244 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013245
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013246 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13247 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13248 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013249
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013250 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013251 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013252
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013253 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13254 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13255 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13256 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013257 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13258 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013259 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13260 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13261 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13262 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13263 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13264 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13265 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13266 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013267 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13268 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13269 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013270 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13271 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13272 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13273 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13274 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013275
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013276 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13277 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13278 the corresponding match text.
13279
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013280 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13281 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13282 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13283 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13284 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013285
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013286 Example :
13287
13288 # this is a comment and is ignored
13289 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13290 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13291 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13292 | | | `---------- value
13293 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13294 | `---------------------------- key
13295 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13296
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013297mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013298 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13299 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013300 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013301 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013302 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013303 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13304 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13305 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13306 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013307 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013308 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013309
13310mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013311 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013312 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13313 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013314 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013315 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013316 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013317 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13318 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13319 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13320 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013321 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013322 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013323
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013324nbsrv
13325 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13326 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13327 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13328 map lookup.
13329
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013330neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013331 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13332 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13333 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13334 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013335
13336not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013337 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013338 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013339 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013340 absence of a flag).
13341
13342odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013343 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013344 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13345
13346or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013347 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013348 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013349 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13350 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013351 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013352 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13353 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13354 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13355 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013356 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013357 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013358
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013359regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013360 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13361 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13362 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13363 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13364 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13365 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13366 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13367 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13368 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13369 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013370 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13371 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13372 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13373 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013374
13375 Example :
13376
13377 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13378 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13379 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13380 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13381
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013382capture-req(<id>)
13383 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13384 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13385
13386 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013387 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13388 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013389
13390capture-res(<id>)
13391 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13392 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13393
13394 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013395 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13396 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013397
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013398sdbm([<avalanche>])
13399 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13400 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13401 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13402 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13403 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13404 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13405 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013406 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13407 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013408
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013409set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013410 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13411 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13412 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013413 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013414 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13415 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013416 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013417 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13418 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013419 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013420 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013421
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013422sha1
13423 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13424 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13425
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013426strcmp(<var>)
13427 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13428 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13429 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13430 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13431 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13432 shorter).
13433
13434 Example :
13435
13436 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13437 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13438 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13439
13440
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013441sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013442 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13443 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013444 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013445 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13446 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013447 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013448 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13449 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013450 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013451 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13452 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013453 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013454 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013455
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013456table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13457 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13458 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13459 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13460 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13461 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13462 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13463
13464
13465table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13466 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13467 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13468 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13469 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13470 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13471 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13472
13473table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13474 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13475 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013476 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013477 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13478 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13479
13480table_conn_cur(<table>)
13481 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13482 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13483 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13484 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13485 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13486
13487table_conn_rate(<table>)
13488 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13489 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13490 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13491 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13492 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13493
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013494table_gpt0(<table>)
13495 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13496 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13497 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13498 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13499 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13500
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013501table_gpc0(<table>)
13502 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13503 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13504 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13505 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13506 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13507
13508table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13509 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13510 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13511 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13512 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13513 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13514 sample fetch keyword.
13515
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013516table_gpc1(<table>)
13517 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13518 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13519 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13520 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13521 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13522
13523table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13524 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13525 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13526 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13527 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13528 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13529 sample fetch keyword.
13530
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013531table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13532 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13533 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013534 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013535 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13536 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13537
13538table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13539 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13540 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13541 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13542 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13543 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13544 keyword.
13545
13546table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13547 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13548 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013549 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013550 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13551 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13552
13553table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13554 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13555 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13556 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13557 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13558 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13559 keyword.
13560
13561table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13562 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13563 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013564 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013565 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13566 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13567 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13568 keyword.
13569
13570table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13571 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13572 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013573 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013574 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13575 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13576 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13577 keyword.
13578
13579table_server_id(<table>)
13580 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13581 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13582 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13583 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13584 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13585 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13586
13587table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13588 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13589 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013590 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013591 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13592 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13593 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13594 keyword.
13595
13596table_sess_rate(<table>)
13597 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13598 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13599 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13600 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13601 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13602 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13603 keyword.
13604
13605table_trackers(<table>)
13606 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13607 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13608 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13609 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13610 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13611 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13612 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13613 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13614 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13615 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13616
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013617upper
13618 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13619 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13620 type. The result is of type string.
13621
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013622url_dec
13623 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13624 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13625
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013626unset-var(<var name>)
13627 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13628 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13629 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13630 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13631 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13632 response),
13633 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13634 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13635 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13636 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13637
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013638utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13639 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13640 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13641 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13642 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13643 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13644 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13645
13646 Example :
13647
13648 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013649 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013650 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13651
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013652word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13653 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13654 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13655 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13656 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13657 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13658
13659 Example :
13660 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13661 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13662 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13663 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13664 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013665
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013666wt6([<avalanche>])
13667 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13668 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13669 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13670 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13671 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13672 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13673 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013674 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13675 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013676
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013677xor(<value>)
13678 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013679 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013680 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013681 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013682 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013683 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13684 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013685 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013686 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13687 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013688 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013689 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013690
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013691xxh32([<seed>])
13692 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13693 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13694 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13695 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13696 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13697 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13698 as cryptographically secure.
13699
13700xxh64([<seed>])
13701 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13702 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13703 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13704 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13705 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13706 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13707 as cryptographically secure.
13708
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013709
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200137107.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013711--------------------------------------------
13712
13713A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13714not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13715"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13716The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13717
13718always_false : boolean
13719 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13720 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13721
13722always_true : boolean
13723 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13724 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13725
13726avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013727 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013728 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13729 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13730 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13731 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13732 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13733 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13734 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13735 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13736 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13737 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13738 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13739 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13740 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013742be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013743 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13744 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13745 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13746 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013747 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
13748
13749be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
13750 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13751 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
13752 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
13753 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
13754 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013755 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
13756 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013757
13758 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
13759 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
13760 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013762be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13763 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13764 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13765 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013766 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013767 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13768 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013769
13770 Example :
13771 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13772 backend dynamic
13773 mode http
13774 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13775 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013776
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013777bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013778 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13779 of the string.
13780
13781bool(<bool>) : bool
13782 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13783 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013785connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13786 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013787 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013788 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13789 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013790
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013791 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013792 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013793 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13794
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013795 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13796 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013797
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013798 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013799 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013800 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013801 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013802 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013803 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013804 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013805
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013806 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13807 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013808 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013809 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013810
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013811date([<offset>]) : integer
13812 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13813 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13814 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13815 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013816 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13817
13818 Example :
13819
13820 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13821 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013822
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010013823date_us : integer
13824 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
13825 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
13826 from the same timeval structure.
13827
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013828distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13829 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13830 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13831 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13832 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13833 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13834 list of supported tokens.
13835
13836distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13837 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13838 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13839 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13840 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13841 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13842 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13843 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13844 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13845 supported tokens.
13846
13847 Example :
13848 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13849 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13850 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13851 # send large files to the big farm
13852 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13853
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013854env(<name>) : string
13855 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13856 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13857 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13858 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13859 certain way.
13860
13861 Examples :
13862 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13863 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13864
13865 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13866 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013868fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13869 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013870 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13871 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013872 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13873 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013874 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013875 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13876 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013877
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013878fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13879 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13880 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13881 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013883fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13884 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13885 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13886 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13887 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13888 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13889 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13890 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13891 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013892
13893 Example :
13894 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13895 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13896 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13897 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13898 frontend mail
13899 bind :25
13900 mode tcp
13901 maxconn 100
13902 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13903 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13904 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13905 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013906
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013907hostname : string
13908 Returns the system hostname.
13909
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013910int(<integer>) : signed integer
13911 Returns a signed integer.
13912
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013913ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13914 Returns an ipv4.
13915
13916ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13917 Returns an ipv6.
13918
13919meth(<method>) : method
13920 Returns a method.
13921
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013922nbproc : integer
13923 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13924 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13925 and debugging purposes.
13926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013927nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13928 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13929 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13930 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013931 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13932 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13933 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013934
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040013935prio_class : integer
13936 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
13937 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
13938 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
13939
13940prio_offset : integer
13941 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
13942 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
13943 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
13944 set-priority-offset".
13945
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013946proc : integer
13947 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13948 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13949 debugging purposes.
13950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013951queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013952 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13953 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13954 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013955 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13956 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13957 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13958 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13959 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13960
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013961rand([<range>]) : integer
13962 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13963 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13964 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13965 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13966 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013968srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13969 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13970 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13971 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13972 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13973 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013974 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
13975 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
13976
13977srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13978 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13979 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
13980 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13981 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
13982 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
13983 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
13984 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
13985
13986 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
13987 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013988
13989srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13990 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13991 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13992 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013993 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013994 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13995 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13996 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13997
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013998srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13999 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14000 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14001 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14002 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14003 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14004 fetch methods.
14005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014006srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14007 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14008 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014009 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014010 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14011 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014012 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014013 overloading servers).
14014
14015 Example :
14016 # Redirect to a separate back
14017 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14018 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14019 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14020
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014021stopping : boolean
14022 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14023 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14024 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14025
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014026str(<string>) : string
14027 Returns a string.
14028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014029table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14030 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14031 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14032
14033table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14034 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14035 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14036 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14037
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014038thread : integer
14039 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14040 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14041 and debugging purposes.
14042
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014043var(<var-name>) : undefined
14044 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014045 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14046 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014047 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014048 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14049 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014050 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014051 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14052 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014053 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014054 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014055
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140567.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014057----------------------------------
14058
14059The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14060closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14061methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14062sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14063TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014064the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14065counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014066"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14067used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14068can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14069Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14070table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14071tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14072currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014073
14074be_id : integer
14075 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14076 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14077
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014078be_name : string
14079 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14080 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014082dst : ip
14083 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14084 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14085 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14086 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
14087 RFC 4291.
14088
14089dst_conn : integer
14090 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14091 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14092 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14093 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14094 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14095 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14096 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14097 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014098
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014099dst_is_local : boolean
14100 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14101 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14102 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14103 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014104 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014105 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14106 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14107 it only once per connection.
14108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014109dst_port : integer
14110 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14111 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14112 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14113 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14114 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14115 an HTTP header.
14116
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014117fc_http_major : integer
14118 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14119 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14120 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14121
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014122fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14123 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14124 header.
14125
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014126fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14127 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14128 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14129 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14130 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14131 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14132 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14133
14134fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14135 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14136 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14137 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14138 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14139 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14140 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14141
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014142fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14143 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14144 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14145 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14146 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14147
14148fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14149 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14150 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14151 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14152 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14153
14154fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14155 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14156 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14157 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14158 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14159
14160fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14161 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14162 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14163 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14164 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14165
14166fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14167 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14168 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14169 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14170 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14171
14172fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14173 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14174 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14175 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14176 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14177
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014178fe_defbe : string
14179 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14180 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014182fe_id : integer
14183 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014184 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014185 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14186
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014187fe_name : string
14188 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14189 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14190 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14191
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014192sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014193sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14194sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14195sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014196 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14197 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14198 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14199
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014200sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014201sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14202sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14203sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014204 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14205 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14206 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14207
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014208sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014209sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14210sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14211sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014212 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14213 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014214 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14215 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14216 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014217
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014218 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014219 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14220 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014221 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14222 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14223 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014224 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14225 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14226
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014227sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14228sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14229sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14230sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14231 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14232 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14233 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14234 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14235 when a first ACL was verified.
14236
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014237sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014238sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14239sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14240sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014241 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014242 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14243
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014244sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014245sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14246sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14247sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014248 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14249 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14250 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14251
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014252sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014253sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14254sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14255sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014256 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14257 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14258 See also src_conn_rate.
14259
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014260sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014261sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14262sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14263sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014264 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014265 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014266
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014267sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14268sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14269sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14270sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14271 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14272 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14273
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014274sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14275sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14276sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14277sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14278 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14279 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14280
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014281sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014282sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14283sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14284sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014285 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14286 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14287 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014288 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14289 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14290 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014291
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014292sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14293sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14294sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14295sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14296 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14297 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14298 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14299 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14300 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14301 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14302
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014303sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014304sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14305sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14306sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014307 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014308 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14309 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14310
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014311sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014312sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14313sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14314sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014315 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14316 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14317 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14318 src_http_err_rate.
14319
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014320sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014321sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14322sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14323sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014324 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014325 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14326 src_http_req_cnt.
14327
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014328sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014329sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14330sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14331sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014332 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14333 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14334 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14335 src_http_req_rate.
14336
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014337sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014338sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14339sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14340sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014341 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014342 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14343 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14344 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14345 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014346
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014347 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014348 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14349 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014350 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14351
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014352sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14353sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14354sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14355sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14356 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14357 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14358 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14359 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14360 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14361
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014362sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014363sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14364sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14365sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014366 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14367 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14368 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014369
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014370sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014371sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14372sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14373sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014374 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14375 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14376 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014378sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014379sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14380sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14381sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014382 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014383 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14384 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14385 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014386 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014387 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14388
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014389sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014390sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14391sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14392sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014393 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14394 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14395 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14396 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14397 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014398 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014399
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014400sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014401sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14402sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14403sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014404 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14405 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14406 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014408sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014409sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14410sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14411sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014412 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14413 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014414 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014415 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14416 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014417 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14418 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14419 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014421so_id : integer
14422 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14423 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14424 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014426src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014427 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014428 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14429 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14430 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014431 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14432 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14433 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
14434 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014435
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014436 Example:
14437 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14438 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014440src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14441 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14442 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14443 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014444 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014446src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14447 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14448 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014449 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014450 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014452src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14453 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14454 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14455 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14456 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14457 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14458 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014459
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014460 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014461 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14462 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14463 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14464 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014465 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014466 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14467 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14468
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014469src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14470 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14471 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14472 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14473 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14474 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14475 was verified.
14476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014477src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014478 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014479 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014480 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014481 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014483src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014484 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014485 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14486 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014487 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014489src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14490 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14491 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14492 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014493 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014495src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014496 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014497 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014498 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014499 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014500
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014501src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14502 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14503 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14504 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14505 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14506
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014507src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14508 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14509 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14510 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14511 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014513src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014514 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014515 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014516 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14517 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014518 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14519 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14520 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014521
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014522src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14523 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14524 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14525 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14526 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14527 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14528 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14529 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014531src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014532 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014533 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014534 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014535 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014536 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014538src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14539 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14540 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14541 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14542 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014543 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014545src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014546 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014547 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14548 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014549 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014551src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14552 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14553 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14554 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014555 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014556 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014558src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14559 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14560 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14561 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014562 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014563 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14564 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014565
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014566 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014567 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014568 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014569 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014570
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014571src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14572 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14573 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14574 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14575 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14576 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14577 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14578
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014579src_is_local : boolean
14580 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14581 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14582 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14583 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014584 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014585 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14586 once per connection.
14587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014588src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014589 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14590 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14591 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14592 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14593 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014595src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014596 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14597 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14598 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14599 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14600 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014602src_port : integer
14603 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14604 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14605 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14606 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014608src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014609 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014610 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14611 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14612 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014613 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014615src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14616 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14617 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14618 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14619 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014620 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014622src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14623 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14624 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14625 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14626 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14627 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14628 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14629 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14630 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014631
14632 Example :
14633 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14634 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14635 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14636 listen ssh
14637 bind :22
14638 mode tcp
14639 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014640 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014641 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014642 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014644srv_id : integer
14645 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14646 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14647 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014648
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146497.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014650----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014652The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14653closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14654when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14655usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014656future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014657
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001465851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14659 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14660 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14661 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14662 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14663 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14664
14665 Example :
14666 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14667 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14668 # the request.
14669 frontend http-in
14670 bind *:8081
14671 default_backend servers
14672 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14673 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14674
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014675ssl_bc : boolean
14676 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14677 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14678 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14679
14680ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14681 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14682 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14683
14684ssl_bc_cipher : string
14685 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14686 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14687
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010014688ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
14689 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14690 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
14691 session or a TLS ticket.
14692
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014693ssl_bc_protocol : string
14694 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14695 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14696
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014697ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014698 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014699 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14700 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014701
14702ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14703 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14704 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14705 if session was reused or not.
14706
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040014707ssl_bc_session_key : binary
14708 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
14709 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
14710 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
14711 BoringSSL.
14712
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014713ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14714 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14715 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014717ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14718 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14719 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14720 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14721 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14722 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014724ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14725 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14726 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14727 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14728 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014729
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014730ssl_c_der : binary
14731 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14732 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14733 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014735ssl_c_err : integer
14736 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14737 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14738 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14739 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14740 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014742ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14743 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14744 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14745 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14746 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14747 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14748 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14749 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14750 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014752ssl_c_key_alg : string
14753 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14754 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14755 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014757ssl_c_notafter : string
14758 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14759 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14760 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014762ssl_c_notbefore : string
14763 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14764 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14765 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014767ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14768 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14769 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14770 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14771 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14772 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14773 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14774 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14775 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014777ssl_c_serial : binary
14778 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14779 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14780 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14783 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14784 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14785 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014786 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14787 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14788
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014789 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014790 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014792ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14793 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14794 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14795 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014797ssl_c_used : boolean
14798 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14799 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014801ssl_c_verify : integer
14802 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14803 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14804 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14805 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807ssl_c_version : integer
14808 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14809 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014810
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014811ssl_f_der : binary
14812 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14813 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14814 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014816ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14817 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14818 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14819 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14820 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014821 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014822 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14823 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14824 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826ssl_f_key_alg : string
14827 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14828 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14829 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014831ssl_f_notafter : string
14832 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14833 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14834 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014836ssl_f_notbefore : string
14837 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14838 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14839 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014841ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14842 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14843 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14844 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14845 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14846 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14847 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14848 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14849 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014851ssl_f_serial : binary
14852 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14853 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14854 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014855
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014856ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14857 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14858 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14859 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014861ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14862 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14863 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14864 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866ssl_f_version : integer
14867 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14868 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14869
14870ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014871 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14872 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14873 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014875 Example :
14876 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14877 listen http-https
14878 bind :80
14879 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14880 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14881
14882ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14883 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14884 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14885
14886ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014887 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14889 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14890 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14891 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14892 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14893 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14894 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14895 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014897ssl_fc_cipher : string
14898 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14899 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014900
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014901ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14902 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14903 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014904 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014905
14906ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14907 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14908 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014909 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014910
14911ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14912 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14913 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14914 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014915 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014916 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014917
14918ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14919 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14920 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014921 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014923ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014924 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14925 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014926 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14927 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14928 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14929 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014930
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014931ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14932 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14933 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14934 wait until the handshake happened.
14935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014936ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14937 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014938 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14939 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14940 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14941 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014942
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014943ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014944 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010014945 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
14946 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014948ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014949 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14951 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14952 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14953 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14954 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14955 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14956 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014958ssl_fc_protocol : string
14959 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14960 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014961
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014962ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014963 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014964 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14965 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14968 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14969 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14970 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14971 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014972
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040014973ssl_fc_session_key : binary
14974 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
14975 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
14976 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
14977 BoringSSL.
14978
14979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014980ssl_fc_sni : string
14981 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14982 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14983 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14984 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14985 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14986
14987 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14988 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14989 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014990 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14991 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014994 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14995 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014997ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14998 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14999 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015000
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015001
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150027.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015003------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015005Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15006sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15007only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15008For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15009be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15010can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15011sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15012for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15013content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015015payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015016 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15018 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015020payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15021 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015022 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015023 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015024
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015025req.hdrs : string
15026 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15027 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15028 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15029 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15030
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015031req.hdrs_bin : binary
15032 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15033 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15034 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15035 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15036 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15037 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15038
15039 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15040
15041 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15042 str: <int:length><bytes>
15043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015044req.len : integer
15045req_len : integer (deprecated)
15046 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15047 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15048 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15049 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15050 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15051 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15052 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15053 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015055req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15056 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015057 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15058 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15059 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15060 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015062 ACL alternatives :
15063 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015065req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15066 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15067 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15068 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15069 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015071 ACL alternatives :
15072 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076req.proto_http : boolean
15077req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15078 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15079 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15080 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15081 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15082 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15083 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15084 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086 Example:
15087 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15088 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15089 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015090 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015092req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15093rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15094 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15095 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15096 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15097 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15098 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15099 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15100 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15103 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15104 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15105 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15106 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15107 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015109 ACL derivatives :
15110 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015112 Example :
15113 listen tse-farm
15114 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15115 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15116 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15117 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15118 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15119 persist rdp-cookie
15120 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15121 # This is only useful makes sense if
15122 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15123 stick-table type string size 204800
15124 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15125 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15126 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15129 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015131req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15132rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15133 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15134 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15135 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15136 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015138 ACL derivatives :
15139 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015140
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015141req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15142 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15143 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015144 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15145 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15146 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15147 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15148 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015150req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15151req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15152 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15153 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15154 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15155 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15156 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15157 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15158 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015160req.ssl_sni : string
15161req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15162 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15163 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15164 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15165 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15166 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15167 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15168 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15169 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15170 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15171 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15172 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15173 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015175 ACL derivatives :
15176 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015178 Examples :
15179 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15180 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15181 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15182 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15183 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015184
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015185req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15186 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15187 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15188 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15189 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15190 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15191 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15192 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15193 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15194 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015196req.ssl_ver : integer
15197req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15198 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15199 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15200 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15201 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15202 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15203 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15204 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015205 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015206 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015208 ACL derivatives :
15209 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015210
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015211res.len : integer
15212 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15213 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15214 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15215 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15216 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15217 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15218 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15219 content inspection.
15220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015221res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15222 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015223 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15224 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15225 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15226 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015228res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15229 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15230 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15231 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15232 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015234 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015235
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015236res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15237rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15238 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15239 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15240 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15241 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15242 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15243 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15244 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246wait_end : boolean
15247 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15248 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015249 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015250 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15251 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015252 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015253 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15254 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015256 Examples :
15257 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15258 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15259 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015261 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15262 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15263 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15264 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15265 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15266 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15267 tcp-request content reject
15268
15269
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152707.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015271--------------------------------------
15272
15273It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15274This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15275data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15276its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15277HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15278content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15279to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15280more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15281response are indexed.
15282
15283base : string
15284 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15285 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15286 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15287 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15288 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15289 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15290 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15291 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15292
15293 ACL derivatives :
15294 base : exact string match
15295 base_beg : prefix match
15296 base_dir : subdir match
15297 base_dom : domain match
15298 base_end : suffix match
15299 base_len : length match
15300 base_reg : regex match
15301 base_sub : substring match
15302
15303base32 : integer
15304 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15305 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15306 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015307 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15308 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15309 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015310
15311base32+src : binary
15312 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15313 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15314 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15315 per-URL counters.
15316
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015317capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15318 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15319 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15320 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15321
15322capture.req.method : string
15323 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15324 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15325 because it's allocated.
15326
15327capture.req.uri : string
15328 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15329 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15330 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15331 allocated.
15332
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015333capture.req.ver : string
15334 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15335 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15336 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15337
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015338capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15339 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15340 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15341 The first entry is an index of 0.
15342 See also: "capture response header"
15343
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015344capture.res.ver : string
15345 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15346 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15347 persistent flag.
15348
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015349req.body : binary
15350 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15351 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15352 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15353 the first chunk is analyzed.
15354
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015355req.body_param([<name>) : string
15356 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15357 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15358 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15359 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15360 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15361 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15362 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15363 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15364 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15365 given.
15366
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015367req.body_len : integer
15368 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15369 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15370 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15371 "option http-buffer-request".
15372
15373req.body_size : integer
15374 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15375 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15376 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15377 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15378 "option http-buffer-request".
15379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015380req.cook([<name>]) : string
15381cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15382 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15383 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15384 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15385 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15386 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15387 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15388 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15389 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15390
15391 ACL derivatives :
15392 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15393 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15394 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15395 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15396 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15397 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15398 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15399 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015401req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15402cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15403 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15404 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015406req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15407cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15408 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15409 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15410 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15411 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015413cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15414 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15415 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15416 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15417 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015418 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15420 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15421 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15422 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015424hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15425 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15426 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15427 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15428 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015429 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15432 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15433 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15434 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15435 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15436 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15437 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15438 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15439 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15442 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15443 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15444 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15445 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015447req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15448 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15449 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15450 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15451 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15452 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15453 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15454 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15455 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015456 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015458 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460 ACL derivatives :
15461 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15462 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15463 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15464 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15465 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15466 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15467 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15468 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15469
15470req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15471hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15472 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15473 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15474 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15475 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15476 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15477 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15478 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15479 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15480 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15481
15482req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15483hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15484 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15485 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15486 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15487 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15488 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015489 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15491 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15492
15493req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15494hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15495 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15496 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15497 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15498 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15499 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15500 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15501 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15502
15503http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15504 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15505 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15506 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15507 basic auth is supported.
15508
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015509http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15510 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15511 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15512 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15513 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15515 basic auth is supported.
15516
15517 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015518 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15519 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15520 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15521 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522
15523http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015524 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15525 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015526 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15527 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015529method : integer + string
15530 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15531 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15532 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15533 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15534 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15535 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15536 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538 ACL derivatives :
15539 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015541 Example :
15542 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15543 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15544 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546path : string
15547 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15548 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15549 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15550 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15551 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015552 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555 ACL derivatives :
15556 path : exact string match
15557 path_beg : prefix match
15558 path_dir : subdir match
15559 path_dom : domain match
15560 path_end : suffix match
15561 path_len : length match
15562 path_reg : regex match
15563 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015564
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015565query : string
15566 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15567 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15568 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15569 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015570 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015571 which stops before the question mark.
15572
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015573req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15574 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15575 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15576 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15577 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015579req.ver : string
15580req_ver : string (deprecated)
15581 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15582 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15583 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015585 ACL derivatives :
15586 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588res.comp : boolean
15589 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15590 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15591 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593res.comp_algo : string
15594 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15595 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15596 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598res.cook([<name>]) : string
15599scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15600 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15601 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15602 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604 ACL derivatives :
15605 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15608scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15609 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15610 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15611 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15614scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15615 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15616 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15617 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15620 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15621 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15622 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15623 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15624 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15625 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15626 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15627 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15628 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15631 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15632 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15633 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15634 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15635 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15638shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15639 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15640 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15641 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15642 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15643 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15644 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15645 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15646 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648 ACL derivatives :
15649 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15650 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15651 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15652 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15653 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15654 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15655 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15656 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15657
15658res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15659shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15660 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15661 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15662 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15663 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15664 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15667shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15668 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15669 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15670 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15671 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15672 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15673 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015674
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015675res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15676 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15677 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15678 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15679 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15682shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15683 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15684 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15685 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15686 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15687 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15688 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690res.ver : string
15691resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15692 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15693 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695 ACL derivatives :
15696 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15699 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15700 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015701 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15705 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707status : integer
15708 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15709 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15710 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015711
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015712unique-id : string
15713 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15714 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15715 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15716 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15717 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15718 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720url : string
15721 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15722 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15723 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15724 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15725 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15726 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15727 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729 ACL derivatives :
15730 url : exact string match
15731 url_beg : prefix match
15732 url_dir : subdir match
15733 url_dom : domain match
15734 url_end : suffix match
15735 url_len : length match
15736 url_reg : regex match
15737 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015739url_ip : ip
15740 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15741 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15742 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15743 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15744 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15745 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15746 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015748url_port : integer
15749 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15750 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15751 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15752 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015753
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015754urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15755url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015756 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15757 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015758 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15759 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15760 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15761 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15763 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015764 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15765 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015767 ACL derivatives :
15768 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15769 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15770 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15771 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15772 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15773 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15774 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15775 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015776
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015778 Example :
15779 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15780 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15781 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15782 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015783
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015784urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015785 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15786 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15787 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015788
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015789url32 : integer
15790 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15791 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15792 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15793 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15794 is an unsigned integer.
15795
15796url32+src : binary
15797 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15798 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15799 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15800
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158027.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015803---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015805Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15806every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015807order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015809ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15810---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015811FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015812HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015813HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15814HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015815HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15816HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15817HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15818HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15819LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015820METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015821METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015822METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15823METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15824METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15825METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015826METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015827METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015828RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015829REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015830TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015831WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15832---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015833
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015834
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158358. Logging
15836----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015837
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015838One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15839provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15840very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15841provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15842state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015843to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015844headers.
15845
15846In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15847about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15848send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15849
15850 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15851 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15852 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15853 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15854 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015855 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015856 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015857
15858The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15859allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15860as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15861while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15862real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15863delay.
15864
15865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158668.1. Log levels
15867---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015868
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015869TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015870source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015871HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15872in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15873track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15874syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15875about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015876
15877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158788.2. Log formats
15879----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015880
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015881HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015882and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15883slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15884options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015885
15886 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15887 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15888 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15889 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15890 extents.
15891
15892 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15893 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15894 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15895 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15896 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15897
15898 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15899 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15900 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15901 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15902 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15903
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015904 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15905 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15906 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15907 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15908
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015909 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15910
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015911Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15912specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15913field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15914servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15915always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15916identifier.
15917
15918Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15919 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15920 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15921 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15922 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15923
15924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159258.2.1. Default log format
15926-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015927
15928This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15929as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15930format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15931
15932 Example :
15933 listen www
15934 mode http
15935 log global
15936 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15937
15938 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15939 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15940 (www/HTTP)
15941
15942 Field Format Extract from the example above
15943 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15944 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15945 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15946 4 'to' to
15947 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15948 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15949
15950Detailed fields description :
15951 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15952 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15953 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15954 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15955 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15956 and processed the connection.
15957 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15958
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015959In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15960"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15961connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15962
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015963It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15964will eventually disappear.
15965
15966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159678.2.2. TCP log format
15968---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015969
15970The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15971is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15972information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15973counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15974emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15975environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15976the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15977sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015978specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15979not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15980fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15981marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015982
15983 Example :
15984 frontend fnt
15985 mode tcp
15986 option tcplog
15987 log global
15988 default_backend bck
15989
15990 backend bck
15991 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15992
15993 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15994 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15995 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15996
15997 Field Format Extract from the example above
15998 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15999 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16000 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16001 4 frontend_name fnt
16002 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16003 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16004 7 bytes_read* 212
16005 8 termination_state --
16006 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16007 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16008
16009Detailed fields description :
16010 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016011 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16012 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16013 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016014 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016015 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016016 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016017
16018 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016019 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16020 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16021 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016022
16023 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16024 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16025 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016026 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16027 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16028 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16029 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016030
16031 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16032 and processed the connection.
16033
16034 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16035 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16036 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16037 applications.
16038
16039 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16040 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16041 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16042 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16043 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16044
16045 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16046 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16047 See "Timers" below for more details.
16048
16049 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16050 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16051 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16052 "Timers" below for more details.
16053
16054 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016055 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016056 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16057 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16058 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16059 details.
16060
16061 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16062 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16063 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16064 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16065 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16066
16067 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16068 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16069 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16070 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16071 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16072 for more details.
16073
16074 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016075 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016076 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16077 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16078 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016079 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016080
16081 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16082 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16083 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16084 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16085 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16086 caused by a denial of service attack.
16087
16088 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16089 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16090 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16091 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16092 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16093 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16094 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16095 denial of service attack.
16096
16097 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16098 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16099 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16100 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16101 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16102 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16103 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16104 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16105 be processed than on other servers.
16106
16107 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16108 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16109 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16110 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16111 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16112 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16113 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16114 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16115 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16116 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16117 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16118 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16119 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16120
16121 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16122 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16123 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16124 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16125 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16126 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016127 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016128 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16129
16130 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16131 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16132 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16133 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16134 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16135 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016136 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016137 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16138 occurs.
16139
16140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161418.2.3. HTTP log format
16142----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016143
16144The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16145is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16146the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16147are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16148emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16149generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16150"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16151which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016152frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16153is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016154
16155Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16156slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16157with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16158
16159 Example :
16160 frontend http-in
16161 mode http
16162 option httplog
16163 log global
16164 default_backend bck
16165
16166 backend static
16167 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16168
16169 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16170 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16171 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016172 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016173
16174 Field Format Extract from the example above
16175 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16176 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016177 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016178 4 frontend_name http-in
16179 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016180 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016181 7 status_code 200
16182 8 bytes_read* 2750
16183 9 captured_request_cookie -
16184 10 captured_response_cookie -
16185 11 termination_state ----
16186 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16187 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16188 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16189 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16190 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016191
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016192Detailed fields description :
16193 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016194 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16195 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16196 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016197 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016198 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016199 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016200
16201 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016202 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16203 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16204 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016205
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016206 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16207 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016208
16209 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16210 and processed the connection.
16211
16212 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16213 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16214 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16215
16216 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16217 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16218 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16219 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16220 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16221 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16222
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016223 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16224 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16225 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16226 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16227 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16228 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016229 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16230 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016231
16232 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16233 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016234 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016235
16236 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16237 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016238 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16239 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016240
16241 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16242 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16243 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16244 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16245 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016246 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16247 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016248
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016249 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16250 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16251 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16252 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16253 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16254 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16255 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016256 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016257
16258 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16259 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16260 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16261
16262 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16263 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16264 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16265 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16266 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16267 overflowing.
16268
16269 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16270 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16271 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16272 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16273 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16274 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16275 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16276 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16277
16278 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16279 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16280 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16281 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16282 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16283 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16284 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16285 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16286
16287 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16288 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16289 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16290 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16291 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16292 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16293 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16294
16295 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016296 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016297 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16298 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16299 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016300 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016301 system.
16302
16303 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16304 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16305 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16306 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16307 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16308 caused by a denial of service attack.
16309
16310 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16311 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16312 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16313 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16314 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16315 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16316 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16317 denial of service attack.
16318
16319 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16320 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16321 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16322 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16323 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16324 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16325 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16326 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16327 processed than on other servers.
16328
16329 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16330 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16331 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16332 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16333 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16334 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16335 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16336 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16337 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16338 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16339 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16340 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16341 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16342
16343 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16344 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16345 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16346 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16347 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16348 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016349 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016350 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16351
16352 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16353 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16354 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16355 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16356 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16357 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016358 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016359 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16360 occurs.
16361
16362 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16363 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16364 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16365 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16366 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16367 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16368 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16369 cookies" below for more details.
16370
16371 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16372 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16373 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16374 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16375 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16376 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16377 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16378 and cookies" below for more details.
16379
16380 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16381 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16382 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16383 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16384 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16385 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16386 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16387 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16388
16389
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200163908.2.4. Custom log format
16391------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016392
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016393The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016394mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016395
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016396HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016397Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16398separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16399prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16400
16401Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16402variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016403("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016404
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016405If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016406as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016407less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16408the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16409
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016410Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016411In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016412in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016413
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016414Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16415'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16416https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16417such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16418
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016419Flags are :
16420 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016421 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016422 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16423 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016424
16425 Example:
16426
16427 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16428 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16429
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016430 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16431
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016432At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16433
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016434 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16435 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016436
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016437the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016438
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016439 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16440 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16441 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016442
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016443and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16444
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016445 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16446 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016447
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016448Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16449
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016450 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016451 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016452 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16453 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16454 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016455 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16456 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16457 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016458 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016459 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16460 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016461 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016462 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16463 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016464 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016465 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016466 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016467 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016468 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016469 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016470 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016471 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16472 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16473 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16474 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16475 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016476 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016477 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16478 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016479 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016480 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16481 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016482 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16483 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16484 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016485 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016486 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16487 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016488 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016489 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16490 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16491 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016492 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016493 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016494 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16495 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16496 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16497 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016498 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016499 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016500 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016501 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016502 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016503 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016504 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16505 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16506 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016507 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016508 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16509 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016510 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016511 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16512 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016513 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016514 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016515 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016516 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016517
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016518 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016519
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016520
165218.2.5. Error log format
16522-----------------------
16523
16524When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16525protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16526By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16527"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016528will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016529logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16530
16531The format looks like this :
16532
16533 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16534 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16535 Connection error during SSL handshake
16536
16537 Field Format Extract from the example above
16538 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16539 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16540 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16541 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16542 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16543
16544These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16545failures.
16546
16547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165488.3. Advanced logging options
16549-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016550
16551Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16552just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16553options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16554for more information about their usage.
16555
16556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165578.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16558------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016559
16560It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16561haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16562commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16563monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16564ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16565
16566 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16567 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16568 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16569 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16570
16571 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16572 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16573 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016574 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016575 such as other load-balancers.
16576
16577 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16578 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16579 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16580
16581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165828.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16583----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016584
16585The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16586what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16587or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016588"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016589just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16590log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16591after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16592is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16593with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16594with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16595
16596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16598------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016599
16600Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16601for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16602"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16603retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16604raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16605a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16606file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16607you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16608"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16609
16610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166118.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16612--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016613
16614Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16615multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16616them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16617"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16618logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16619error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16620and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16621too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16622useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16623alternative.
16624
16625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166268.4. Timing events
16627------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016628
16629Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16630reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16631the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16632frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016633mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16634addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16635
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016636Timings events in HTTP mode:
16637
16638 first request 2nd request
16639 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16640 t tr t tr ...
16641 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16642 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16643 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16644 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16645 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16646
16647Timings events in TCP mode:
16648
16649 TCP session
16650 |<----------------->|
16651 t t
16652 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16653 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16654 |<------ Tt ------->|
16655
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016656 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016657 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016658 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16659 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16660 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016661 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016662 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
16663 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
16664 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
16665 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016666
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016667 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16668 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16669 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016670 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
16671 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
16672 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
16673 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
16674 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
16675 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016676
16677 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16678 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16679 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16680 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16681 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16682 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16683 request typed by hand during a test.
16684
16685 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16686 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016687 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016688 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16689 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16690 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16691 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016692
16693 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16694 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16695 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16696 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16697 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16698
16699 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16700 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16701 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16702 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16703 connection never established.
16704
16705 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16706 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16707 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16708 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16709 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16710 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16711 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16712 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16713 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16714 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16715 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16716
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016717 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16718 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16719 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16720 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16721 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16722 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16723
16724 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16725
16726 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16727 "Ta" can never be negative.
16728
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016729 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16730 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016731 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16732 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016733 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016734
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016735 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016736
16737 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016738 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16739 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016740
16741These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16742protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16743that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016744due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16745"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16746that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016747
16748Most common cases :
16749
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016750 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16751 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16752 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16753 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16754 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16755 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16756 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16757 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16758 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16759 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16760 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016761 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016762
16763 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16764 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16765 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16766 of ms on remote networks.
16767
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016768 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16769 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16770 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016771
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016772 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16773 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16774 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16775 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16776 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16777 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16778 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16779 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16780 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016781
16782Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16783
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016784 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016785 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016786 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016787
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016788 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016789 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16790 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16791
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016792 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016793 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16794 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16795 flags.
16796
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016797 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16798 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016799 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16800 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16801 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16802 the client connection was maintained open.
16803
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016804 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016805 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016806 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016807 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16808
16809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168108.5. Session state at disconnection
16811-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016812
16813TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16814"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
168152-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16816each of which has a special meaning :
16817
16818 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16819 session to terminate :
16820
16821 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16822
16823 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16824 server explicitly refused it.
16825
16826 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16827 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16828 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16829 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016830 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016831
16832 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16833 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016834
16835 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16836 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16837 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16838 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16839 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16840
16841 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16842 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16843 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16844 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16845 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16846
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016847 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16848 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16849
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016850 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16851 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16852 backup connections when going up.
16853
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016854 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16855
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016856 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16857 send or receive data.
16858
16859 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16860 send or receive data.
16861
16862 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16863 with nothing left in the buffers.
16864
16865 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16866
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016867 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016868 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16869
16870 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16871 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16872 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16873 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16874 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16875
16876 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16877 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16878
16879 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16880 server (HTTP only).
16881
16882 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16883
16884 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16885 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16886 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16887
16888 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16889 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16890 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16891
16892 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16893
16894 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16895 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16896
16897 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16898 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16899 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16900
16901 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16902 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016903 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16904 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016905
16906 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16907 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16908 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16909 another server.
16910
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016911 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016912 server.
16913
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016914 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16915 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16916 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16917 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16918
16919 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16920 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16921 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16922 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16923
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016924 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16925 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16926 "use-server" rule).
16927
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016928 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16929
16930 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16931 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16932
16933 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16934
16935 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16936 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16937 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16938
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016939 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16940 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016941 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016942 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16943 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16944
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016945 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16946
16947 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16948 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16949
16950 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16951
16952 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16953
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016954The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16955was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016956helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16957starvation, attacks, etc...
16958
16959The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16960alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16961easier finding and understanding.
16962
16963 Flags Reason
16964
16965 -- Normal termination.
16966
16967 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16968 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16969 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16970 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16971
16972 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16973 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16974 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16975 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16976 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16977 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016978
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016979 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16980 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016981 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016982
16983 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16984 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16985 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16986
16987 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16988 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16989 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16990 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16991 the server takes too long to respond.
16992
16993 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16994 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16995 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16996 long a time to respond.
16997
16998 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16999 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17000 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17001 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017002 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17003 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017004
17005 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17006 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17007 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17008 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17009 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017010 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017011 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17012 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17013 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17014 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17015 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17016 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17017 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17018 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017019 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017020 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17021 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17022 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017023
17024 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17025 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017026 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17027 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17028 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17029 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017030
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017031 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17032 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17033
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017034 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017035 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17036 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017037 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017038 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17039 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17040
17041 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17042 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17043 503 or 504 here.
17044
17045 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17046 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17047 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17048 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17049 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17050
17051 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17052 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017053 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017054 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17055 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17056
17057 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17058 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17059 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17060 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17061 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17062 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17063 between haproxy and the server.
17064
17065 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17066 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17067 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17068 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17069 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17070 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17071 solution is to fix the application.
17072
17073 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17074 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17075 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17076 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17077 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17078 external attacks.
17079
17080 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17081 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017082 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017083 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17084 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17085
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017086 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17087 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17088 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017089 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017090 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017091
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017092 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17093 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17094 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17095 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017096 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17097 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17098 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17099 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17100 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017101
17102 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17103 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17104 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17105 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17106
17107 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17108 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17109 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17110 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17111
17112 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17113 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17114 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17115 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17116
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017117The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17118persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17119important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17120re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17121
17122 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17123
17124 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17125 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17126 set on a GET request.
17127
17128 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17129 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017130 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017131 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17132
17133 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17134 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17135 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17136
17137 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17138 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17139 already got a cookie.
17140
17141 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17142 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17143 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17144 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17145 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17146
17147 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17148 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17149 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17150
17151 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17152 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17153 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17154
17155 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17156 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17157
17158 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17159 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17160 then advertised in the response.
17161
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171638.6. Non-printable characters
17164-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017165
17166In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17167consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17168converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17169prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17170being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17171escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17172is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17173'}' when logging headers.
17174
17175Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17176issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17177containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17178
17179Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17180the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17181performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17182
17183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171848.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17185---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017186
17187Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17188achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017189section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017190cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17191the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17192the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017193locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017194not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17195user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17196a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17197wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17198
17199 Examples :
17200 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17201 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17202
17203 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17204 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17205
17206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172078.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17208---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017209
17210Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17211proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17212the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17213server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17214
17215Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17216response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017217section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017218
17219It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017220time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17221appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017222are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17223and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17224follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17225request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17226in the logs.
17227
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017228As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17229frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17230an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17231
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017232 Example :
17233 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17234 listen proxy-out
17235 mode http
17236 option httplog
17237 option logasap
17238 log global
17239 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17240
17241 # log the name of the virtual server
17242 capture request header Host len 20
17243
17244 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17245 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17246
17247 # log the beginning of the referrer
17248 capture request header Referer len 20
17249
17250 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17251 capture response header Server len 20
17252
17253 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17254 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17255
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017256 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017257 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17258
17259 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17260 capture response header Via len 20
17261
17262 # log the URL location during a redirection
17263 capture response header Location len 20
17264
17265 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17266 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17267 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17268 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17269 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17270
17271 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17272 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17273 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17274 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017275 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017276
17277 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17278 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17279 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17280 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17281 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017282 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017283
17284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172858.9. Examples of logs
17286---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017287
17288These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17289them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17290reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17291
17292 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17293 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17294 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17295
17296 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17297 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17298
17299 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17300 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17301 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17302
17303 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17304 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17305
17306 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17307 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17308 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17309
17310 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017311 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017312 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17313 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17314
17315 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17316 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17317 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17318
17319 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17320 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017321 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017322 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17323 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17324 to return the 502 and not the server.
17325
17326 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017327 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017328
17329 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17330 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17331 Nothing was sent to any server.
17332
17333 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17334 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17335
17336 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17337 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017338 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017339 send a 408 return code to the client.
17340
17341 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17342 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17343
17344 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17345 5 seconds ("c----").
17346
17347 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17348 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017349 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017350
17351 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017352 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017353 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17354 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17355 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17356 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17357 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017358
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017359
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200173609. Supported filters
17361--------------------
17362
17363Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17364accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17365unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17366
17367See also : "filter"
17368
173699.1. Trace
17370----------
17371
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017372filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017373
17374 Arguments:
17375 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17376 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17377
17378 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17379 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17380 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17381 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17382
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017383 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017384 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17385 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17386 amount of the parsed data.
17387
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017388 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017389
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017390This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17391callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17392information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17393filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17394
17395Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17396tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17397a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17398
17399
174009.2. HTTP compression
17401---------------------
17402
17403filter compression
17404
17405The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17406keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
17407when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
17408use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
17409used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
17410filters evaluation order.
17411
17412See also : "compression"
17413
17414
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200174159.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17416--------------------------------------------
17417
17418filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17419
17420 Arguments :
17421
17422 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17423 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17424 parsed.
17425
17426 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17427 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17428 part must be placed in its own scope.
17429
17430The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17431external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017432streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017433exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17434also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17435
17436SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17437the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17438
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017439For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017440"doc/SPOE.txt".
17441
17442Important note:
17443 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17444 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17445
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001744610. Cache
17447---------
17448
17449HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17450(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17451RAM.
17452
17453The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017454this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017455
17456If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17457independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17458when we try to allocate a new one.
17459
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017460The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017461
17462It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17463"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17464for more details.
17465
17466When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17467replaced by "<CACHE>".
17468
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001746910.1. Limitation
17470----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017471
17472The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17473
17474- If the response is not a 200
17475- If the response contains a Vary header
17476- If the response does not contain a Content-Length header or if the
17477 Content-Length + the headers size is greater than a buffer size - the
17478 reserve.
17479- If the response is not cacheable
17480
17481- If the request is not a GET
17482- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017483- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017484
17485Caution!: Due to the current limitation of the filters, it is not recommended
17486to use the cache with other filters. Using them can cause undefined behavior
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017487if they modify the response (compression for example).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017488
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001748910.2. Setup
17490-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017491
17492To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17493the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17494
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001749510.2.1. Cache section
17496---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017497
17498cache <name>
17499 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17500 size of cache is mandatory.
17501
17502total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017503 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
17504 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017505
17506max-age <seconds>
17507 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17508 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17509 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17510 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17511 default.
17512
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001751310.2.2. Proxy section
17514---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017515
17516http-request cache-use <name>
17517 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17518 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17519 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17520 after this one.
17521
17522http-response cache-store <name>
17523 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17524 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17525 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17526 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17527
17528
17529Example:
17530
17531 backend bck1
17532 mode http
17533
17534 http-request cache-use foobar
17535 http-response cache-store foobar
17536 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17537
17538 cache foobar
17539 total-max-size 4
17540 max-age 240
17541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017542/*
17543 * Local variables:
17544 * fill-column: 79
17545 * End:
17546 */